3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle @sc{gnu} Coreutils
9 @include constants.texi
11 @c Define new indices.
15 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
25 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
26 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options. Common options.
27 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
28 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
31 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
32 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
33 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
34 @c * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. FIXME.
36 @dircategory Individual utilities
38 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
39 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
40 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
41 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
42 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
43 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change file permissions.
44 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners/groups.
45 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
46 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
47 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
48 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
49 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
50 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
51 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
52 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
53 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
54 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
55 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
56 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip non-directory suffix.
57 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
58 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
59 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
60 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
61 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
62 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
63 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
64 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
65 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
66 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
67 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
68 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
69 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
70 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
71 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy and change attributes.
72 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
73 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
74 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
75 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
76 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
77 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
78 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
79 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
80 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
81 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
82 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
83 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
84 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
85 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
86 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
87 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
88 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
89 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
90 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
91 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
92 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
93 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
94 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
95 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
96 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
97 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
98 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
99 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
100 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
101 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
102 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
103 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
104 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into fixed-size pieces.
105 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
106 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
107 * su: (coreutils)su invocation. Modify user and group ID.
108 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
109 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory and disk.
110 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
111 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
112 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
113 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
114 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
115 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
116 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
117 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
118 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
119 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
120 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
121 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
122 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
123 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
124 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
125 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
126 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
127 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
128 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
132 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the @sc{gnu} core
133 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
135 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-1996, 2000-2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
138 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
139 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
140 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
141 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
142 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
143 Free Documentation License''.
148 @title @sc{gnu} @code{Coreutils}
149 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
150 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
151 @author David MacKenzie et al.
154 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
166 @cindex core utilities
167 @cindex text utilities
168 @cindex shell utilities
169 @cindex file utilities
172 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors.
173 * Common options:: Common options.
174 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od
175 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
176 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
177 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
178 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
179 * Operating on fields within a line:: cut paste join
180 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
181 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
182 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
183 * Special file types:: ln mkdir rmdir mkfifo mknod
184 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
185 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync
186 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
187 * Conditions:: false true test expr
189 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk
190 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
191 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
192 * System context:: date uname hostname hostid
193 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup su
194 * Process control:: kill
196 * Numeric operations:: factor seq
197 * File permissions:: Access modes.
198 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
199 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy.
200 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
201 * Concept index:: General index.
204 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
208 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
209 * Backup options:: Backup options
210 * Block size:: Block size
211 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
212 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
213 * Target directory:: Target directory
214 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
215 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
216 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
217 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
219 Output of entire files
221 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
222 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
223 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
224 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
225 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
227 Formatting file contents
229 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
230 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
231 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
233 Output of parts of files
235 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
236 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
237 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
238 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
242 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
243 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
244 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
245 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
246 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
247 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
249 Operating on sorted files
251 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
252 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
253 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
254 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
255 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
256 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
258 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
260 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
261 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
262 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
263 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
264 * Compatibility in ptx:: The @acronym{GNU} extensions to @command{ptx}
266 Operating on fields within a line
268 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
269 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
270 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
272 Operating on characters
274 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
275 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
276 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
278 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
280 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
281 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
282 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
286 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
287 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
288 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
289 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
291 @command{ls}: List directory contents
293 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
294 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
295 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
296 * More details about version sort:: More details about version sort
297 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
298 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
302 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
303 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
304 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
305 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
306 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
307 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
311 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
312 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
313 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
314 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
315 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
316 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link
317 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
318 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
320 Changing file attributes
322 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
323 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
324 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
325 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
329 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
330 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
331 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
332 * sync invocation:: Synchronize data on disk with memory
336 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
337 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
338 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
342 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
343 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
344 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
345 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
347 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
349 * File type tests:: File type tests
350 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
351 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
352 * String tests:: String tests
353 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
355 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
357 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
358 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
359 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
360 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
364 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
366 File name manipulation
368 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
369 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
370 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability
374 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
375 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
376 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
377 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
379 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
381 * Control:: Control settings
382 * Input:: Input settings
383 * Output:: Output settings
384 * Local:: Local settings
385 * Combination:: Combination settings
386 * Characters:: Special characters
387 * Special:: Special settings
391 * id invocation:: Print user identity
392 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
393 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
394 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
395 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
396 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
400 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
401 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
402 * uname invocation:: Print system information
403 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
404 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
406 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
408 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
409 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
410 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
411 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
412 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
413 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
414 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
415 * Examples of date:: Examples.
417 Modified command invocation
419 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
420 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
421 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
422 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
423 * su invocation:: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
427 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
431 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
435 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
436 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
440 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits.
441 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits.
442 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers.
443 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
447 * General date syntax:: Common rules.
448 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994.
449 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm.
450 * Time zone items:: @sc{est}, @sc{pdt}, @sc{gmt}.
451 * Day of week items:: Monday and others.
452 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago.
453 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440.
454 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502.
455 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0".
456 * Authors of get_date:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
458 Opening the software toolbox
460 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
461 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
462 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
463 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
464 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
465 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
466 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
470 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
477 @chapter Introduction
479 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
480 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
481 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire @sc{gnu} community
484 @cindex @acronym{POSIX}
485 The @sc{gnu} utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
486 @acronym{POSIX} standard.
487 @cindex bugs, reporting
488 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
489 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
490 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
491 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
492 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
493 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
499 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
502 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
503 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
504 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
505 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
506 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
507 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
508 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
509 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
510 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
511 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
512 insights to the overall process.
515 @chapter Common options
519 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
522 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
523 @cindex backups, making
524 @xref{Backup options}.
525 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
528 @macro optBackupSuffix
529 @item -S @var{suffix}
530 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
533 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
534 @xref{Backup options}.
537 @macro optTargetDirectory
538 @item -t @var{directory}
539 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
541 @opindex --target-directory
542 @cindex target directory
543 @cindex destination directory
544 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
545 @xref{Target directory}.
548 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
550 @itemx --no-target-directory
552 @opindex --no-target-directory
553 @cindex target directory
554 @cindex destination directory
555 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
556 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
563 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
564 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
565 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
566 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
567 @option{--human-readable} option if
568 you prefer powers of 1024.
571 @macro optHumanReadable
573 @itemx --human-readable
575 @opindex --human-readable
576 @cindex human-readable output
577 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
578 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
579 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
580 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
583 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
584 @itemx @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}}
585 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
586 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
587 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
588 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
591 @cindex common options
593 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
594 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
595 described here. (In fact, every @sc{gnu} program accepts (or should accept)
598 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
599 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
600 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
601 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
602 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
603 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
604 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
606 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
607 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
608 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
609 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
610 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
611 specify a command that itself contains options.
613 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
614 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument.
621 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
625 @cindex version number, finding
626 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
630 @cindex option delimiter
631 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
632 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
633 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
637 @cindex standard input
638 @cindex standard output
639 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
640 stands for standard input, or for standard output if that is clear from
641 the context. For example, @samp{sort -} reads from standard input,
642 and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}, and @samp{tee -} writes an
643 extra copy of its input to standard output. Unless otherwise
644 specified, @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
648 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
649 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
650 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
651 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
652 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
653 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
654 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
655 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
656 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
657 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @command{eval}, @dots{}
658 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the @acronym{POSIX} standard.
666 An exit status of zero indicates success,
667 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
670 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
671 that can be used to change how other commands work.
672 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
673 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
674 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as @acronym{POSIX}
675 requires only that it be nonzero.
677 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
678 other exit status values and a few associate different
679 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
680 Here are some of the exceptions:
681 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr},
682 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{printenv},
683 @command{sort}, @command{su}, @command{test}, @command{tty}.
687 @section Backup options
689 @cindex backup options
691 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
692 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
693 before writing new versions.
694 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
695 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
700 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
703 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
704 @cindex backups, making
705 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
706 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
707 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
708 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
709 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
710 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
711 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
713 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
714 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
716 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
717 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
718 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
719 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
720 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
725 @opindex none @r{backup method}
730 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
731 Always make numbered backups.
735 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
736 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
741 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
742 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
743 confused with @samp{none}.
747 @item -S @var{suffix}
748 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
751 @cindex backup suffix
752 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
753 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
754 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
755 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
756 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
765 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
766 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
767 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
768 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
769 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
771 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
774 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
775 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
776 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
777 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
779 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
780 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
785 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
786 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
787 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
790 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
791 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
794 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
795 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
796 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
797 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
798 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
801 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
802 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
803 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
808 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
809 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
810 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
813 @cindex human-readable output
816 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
817 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
818 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
819 that are upward compatible with the
820 @uref{http://www.bipm.fr/enus/3_SI/si-prefixes.html, SI prefixes}
821 for decimal multiples and with the
822 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, IEC 60027-2
823 prefixes for binary multiples}.
825 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
826 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
827 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
828 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
829 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
832 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
833 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
834 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
835 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
836 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
837 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
840 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
841 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
842 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
843 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
844 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
845 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
846 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
848 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
849 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
850 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
853 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
854 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
858 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
859 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
863 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
864 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
865 @samp{k} and the IEC 60027-2 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
866 @acronym{POSIX} use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
868 @cindex megabyte, definition of
869 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
872 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
873 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
875 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
876 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
879 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
880 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
882 @cindex terabyte, definition of
883 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
886 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
887 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
889 @cindex petabyte, definition of
890 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
893 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
894 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
896 @cindex exabyte, definition of
897 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
900 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
901 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
903 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
904 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
907 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
908 (@samp{Zi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
910 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
911 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
914 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
915 (@samp{Yi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
920 @opindex --block-size
921 @opindex --human-readable
924 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
925 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
926 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
927 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
928 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
929 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
930 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}.
932 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
933 @section chown and chgrp: Disambiguating user names and IDs
934 @cindex user names, disambiguating
935 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
936 @cindex group names, disambiguating
937 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
938 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
940 Since the @var{owner} and @var{group} arguments to @command{chown} and
941 @command{chgrp} may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
943 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
944 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
945 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID?
946 @acronym{POSIX} requires that @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
947 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
948 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID.
949 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
950 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
951 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
952 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
953 1000---not what you intended.
955 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp} provide a way to work around this,
956 that at the same time may result in a significant performance improvement
957 by eliminating a database look-up.
958 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
959 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
963 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
967 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
968 skip the name look-up process for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
969 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
970 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
973 @section Sources of random data
975 @cindex random sources
977 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
978 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
979 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
982 Normally these commands use the device file @file{/dev/urandom} as the
983 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
984 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
985 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
986 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
987 cryptographically secure pseudorandom number generator.
989 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
990 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
991 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
992 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
995 To use such a source, specify the @option{--random-source=@var{file}}
996 option, e.g., @samp{shuf --random-source=/dev/random}. The contents
997 of @var{file} should be as random as possible. An error is reported
998 if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes to randomize the input
1001 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1002 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1003 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1005 Some old-fashioned or stripped-down operating systems lack support for
1006 @command{/dev/urandom}. On these systems commands like @command{shuf}
1007 by default fall back on an internal pseudorandom generator initialized
1008 by a small amount of entropy.
1010 @node Target directory
1011 @section Target directory
1013 @cindex target directory
1015 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1016 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1017 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1018 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1019 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1020 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1021 allow more fine-grained control:
1026 @itemx --no-target-directory
1027 @opindex --no-target-directory
1028 @cindex target directory
1029 @cindex destination directory
1030 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1031 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1032 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1033 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1034 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1035 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1036 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1037 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1038 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1040 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1041 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1042 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1044 @item -t @var{directory}
1045 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
1046 @opindex --target-directory
1047 @cindex target directory
1048 @cindex destination directory
1049 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1052 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1053 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1054 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1055 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1056 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1058 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1059 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1060 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1061 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1062 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1063 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1064 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1065 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1068 The @w{@kbd{--target-directory}} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1069 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1070 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1071 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1074 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1077 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1078 If you use the @sc{gnu} @command{find} program, you can move those
1079 files too, with this command:
1082 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1086 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1087 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1088 some other special characters.
1089 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1090 @sc{gnu} @command{find} and @sc{gnu} @command{xargs}:
1093 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1094 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1101 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1102 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1103 options cannot be combined.
1105 @node Trailing slashes
1106 @section Trailing slashes
1108 @cindex trailing slashes
1110 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1111 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1112 operating on it. The @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}} option enables
1115 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1116 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1117 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1118 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1119 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1120 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1121 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1122 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1123 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1124 be the default, it is required by @acronym{POSIX} and is consistent with
1125 other parts of that standard.
1127 @node Traversing symlinks
1128 @section Traversing symlinks
1130 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1132 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1133 @c FIXME: note that `du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1134 @c different meaning.
1135 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1136 option is also specified.
1137 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1139 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1140 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1141 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1143 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1144 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1145 a symlink or its referent.
1152 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is specified on the command line
1153 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1154 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1161 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1162 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1163 that is encountered.
1170 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1171 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1172 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1173 or @option{-P} is specified.
1180 @node Treating / specially
1181 @section Treating / specially
1183 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1184 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1185 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1186 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1187 legitimate uses for such a command,
1188 @sc{gnu} @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1189 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1190 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1191 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1192 @option{--preserve-option}, is safer for most purposes.
1194 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1195 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1196 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1197 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1198 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1199 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1200 interrupt them. Tradition and @acronym{POSIX} require these commands
1201 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1202 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1203 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1204 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1206 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1207 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1208 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1210 @node Special built-in utilities
1211 @section Special built-in utilities
1213 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1214 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1215 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1216 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1217 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1218 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1221 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1222 by @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2004.
1225 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1226 return set shift times trap unset}
1229 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1230 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1231 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1233 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1234 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1235 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1236 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1238 @node Standards conformance
1239 @section Standards conformance
1241 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1242 In a few cases, the @sc{gnu} utilities' default behavior is
1243 incompatible with the @acronym{POSIX} standard. To suppress these
1244 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1245 variable. Unless you are checking for @acronym{POSIX} conformance, you
1246 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1248 Newer versions of @acronym{POSIX} are occasionally incompatible with older
1249 versions. For example, older versions of @acronym{POSIX} required the
1250 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1251 fields in each input line, but starting with @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001
1252 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1253 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1256 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1257 The @sc{gnu} utilities normally conform to the version of @acronym{POSIX}
1258 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1259 different version of @acronym{POSIX}, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1260 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1261 the year and month the standard was adopted. Two values are currently
1262 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1263 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.2-1992, and @samp{200112} stands for @acronym{POSIX}
1264 1003.1-2001. For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1265 that assumes an older version of @acronym{POSIX} and uses @samp{sort +1}
1266 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1267 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1269 @node Output of entire files
1270 @chapter Output of entire files
1272 @cindex output of entire files
1273 @cindex entire files, output of
1275 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1279 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1280 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1281 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1282 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1283 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1286 @node cat invocation
1287 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1290 @cindex concatenate and write files
1291 @cindex copying files
1293 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1294 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1297 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1300 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1308 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1311 @itemx --number-nonblank
1313 @opindex --number-nonblank
1314 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1318 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1323 @opindex --show-ends
1324 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1330 Number all output lines, starting with 1.
1333 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1335 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1336 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1337 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1342 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1347 @opindex --show-tabs
1348 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1352 Ignored; for @acronym{POSIX} compatibility.
1355 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1357 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1358 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1359 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1364 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1365 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1366 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1367 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1368 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1369 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1370 if standard output is a terminal.
1377 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1380 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1385 @node tac invocation
1386 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1389 @cindex reversing files
1391 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1392 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1393 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1396 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1399 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1400 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1401 the record that it follows in the file.
1403 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1411 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1412 precedes in the file.
1418 Treat the separator string as a regular expression. Users of @command{tac}
1419 on MS-DOS/MS-Windows should note that, since @command{tac} reads files in
1420 binary mode, each line of a text file might end with a CR/LF pair
1421 instead of the Unix-style LF.
1423 @item -s @var{separator}
1424 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1426 @opindex --separator
1427 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1435 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1438 @cindex numbering lines
1439 @cindex line numbering
1441 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1442 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1443 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1446 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1449 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1450 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1451 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1452 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1453 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1455 @cindex headers, numbering
1456 @cindex body, numbering
1457 @cindex footers, numbering
1458 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1459 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1460 style from the others.
1462 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1463 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1474 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1475 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1476 length of each string cannot be changed.
1478 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1479 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1480 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1481 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1483 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1487 @item -b @var{style}
1488 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1490 @opindex --body-numbering
1491 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1492 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1493 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1494 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1500 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1502 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1504 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1505 expression @var{bre}.
1506 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1510 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1512 @opindex --section-delimiter
1513 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1514 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1515 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1516 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1517 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1519 @item -f @var{style}
1520 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1522 @opindex --footer-numbering
1523 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1525 @item -h @var{style}
1526 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1528 @opindex --header-numbering
1529 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1531 @item -i @var{number}
1532 @itemx --page-increment=@var{number}
1534 @opindex --page-increment
1535 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1537 @item -l @var{number}
1538 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1540 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1541 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1542 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1543 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1544 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1545 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1546 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1549 @item -n @var{format}
1550 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1552 @opindex --number-format
1553 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1557 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1558 left justified, no leading zeros;
1560 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1561 right justified, no leading zeros;
1563 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1564 right justified, leading zeros.
1568 @itemx --no-renumber
1570 @opindex --no-renumber
1571 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1573 @item -s @var{string}
1574 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1576 @opindex --number-separator
1577 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1578 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1580 @item -v @var{number}
1581 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1583 @opindex --starting-line-number
1584 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1586 @item -w @var{number}
1587 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1589 @opindex --number-width
1590 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1598 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1601 @cindex octal dump of files
1602 @cindex hex dump of files
1603 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1604 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1606 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1607 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1611 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1612 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1613 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1616 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1617 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1618 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1619 printed as a single octal number.
1621 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1622 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1623 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1624 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1625 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1626 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1627 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1629 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1630 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1631 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1632 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1635 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1639 @item -A @var{radix}
1640 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1642 @opindex --address-radix
1643 @cindex radix for file offsets
1644 @cindex file offset radix
1645 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1646 be one of the following:
1656 none (do not print offsets).
1659 The default is octal.
1661 @item -j @var{bytes}
1662 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1664 @opindex --skip-bytes
1665 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1666 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1667 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1668 in decimal. Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
1669 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
1670 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
1671 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
1672 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
1674 @item -N @var{bytes}
1675 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1677 @opindex --read-bytes
1678 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1679 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1681 @item -S @var{bytes}
1682 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1685 @cindex string constants, outputting
1686 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1687 least @var{bytes} consecutive @acronym{ASCII} graphic characters,
1688 followed by a null (zero) byte.
1689 Prefixes and suffixes on @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1692 If @var{n} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1695 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1698 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1699 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1700 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1701 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1702 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1703 in the order that you specified.
1705 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1706 of the @acronym{ASCII} character representation of the printable characters
1707 to the output line generated by the type specification.
1711 named character, ignoring high-order bit
1713 @acronym{ASCII} character or backslash escape,
1726 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
1727 newline, and @samp{nul} for a null (zero) byte. Only the least significant
1728 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
1729 Type @code{c} outputs
1730 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
1733 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
1734 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
1735 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
1736 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
1737 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
1738 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
1739 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
1752 For floating point (@code{f}):
1764 @itemx --output-duplicates
1766 @opindex --output-duplicates
1767 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
1768 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
1769 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
1770 indicate the elision.
1773 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
1776 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
1777 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
1780 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
1781 omitted, the default is 32.
1785 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
1786 @sc{gnu} @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
1787 specification options. These options accumulate.
1793 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
1797 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
1801 Output as @acronym{ASCII} characters or backslash escapes. Equivalent to
1806 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
1810 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
1814 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
1818 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
1822 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
1826 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
1830 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
1833 @opindex --traditional
1834 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
1835 accepted. The following syntax:
1838 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1842 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
1843 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
1844 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
1845 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
1846 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
1853 @node base64 invocation
1854 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data.
1857 @cindex base64 encoding
1859 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
1860 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
1861 printable @acronym{ASCII} characters to represent binary data, see
1862 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3548.txt, RFC 3548}.
1866 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1867 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1870 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
1872 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1877 @itemx --wrap=@var{COLS}
1881 @cindex column to wrap data after
1882 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{COLS} characters. This must be
1885 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
1886 disable line wrapping altogether.
1892 @cindex Decode base64 data
1893 @cindex Base64 decoding
1894 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
1895 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
1896 output will be the original data.
1899 @itemx --ignore-garbage
1901 @opindex --ignore-garbage
1902 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
1903 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
1904 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
1905 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
1912 @node Formatting file contents
1913 @chapter Formatting file contents
1915 @cindex formatting file contents
1917 These commands reformat the contents of files.
1920 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
1921 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
1922 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
1926 @node fmt invocation
1927 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
1930 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
1931 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
1932 @cindex text, reformatting
1934 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
1935 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
1938 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1941 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
1942 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
1944 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
1945 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
1946 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
1949 @cindex line-breaking
1950 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
1951 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
1952 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
1953 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
1954 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
1955 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
1956 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
1957 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
1958 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
1959 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
1960 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
1961 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
1964 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1969 @itemx --crown-margin
1971 @opindex --crown-margin
1972 @cindex crown margin
1973 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
1974 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
1975 line with that of the second line.
1978 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
1980 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
1981 @cindex tagged paragraphs
1982 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
1983 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
1984 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
1990 @opindex --split-only
1991 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
1992 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
1993 being unduly combined.
1996 @itemx --uniform-spacing
1998 @opindex --uniform-spacing
1999 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2000 between sentences to two spaces.
2003 @itemx -w @var{width}
2004 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2005 @opindex -@var{width}
2008 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75). @command{fmt}
2009 initially tries to make lines about 7% shorter than this, to give it
2010 room to balance line lengths.
2012 @item -p @var{prefix}
2013 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2014 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2015 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2016 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2017 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2018 leaving the code unchanged.
2026 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2029 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2030 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2031 @cindex merging files in parallel
2033 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2034 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2035 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2036 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2039 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2043 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2044 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2045 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2046 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2047 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2048 The text line of the header takes the form
2049 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2050 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2051 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2052 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2053 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2054 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2055 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2058 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2059 feeds produce empty pages.
2061 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2062 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2063 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2065 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2066 truncate lines in that case.
2068 The following changes were made in version 1.22i and apply to later
2069 versions of @command{pr}:
2070 @c FIXME: this whole section here sounds very awkward to me. I
2071 @c made a few small changes, but really it all needs to be redone. - Brian
2072 @c OK, I fixed another sentence or two, but some of it I just don't understand.
2077 Some small @var{letter options} (@option{-s}, @option{-w}) have been
2078 redefined for better @acronym{POSIX} compliance. The output of some further
2079 cases has been adapted to other Unix systems. These changes are not
2080 compatible with earlier versions of the program.
2083 Some @var{new capital letter} options (@option{-J}, @option{-S}, @option{-W})
2084 have been introduced to turn off unexpected interferences of small letter
2085 options. The @option{-N} option and the second argument @var{last_page}
2086 of @samp{+FIRST_PAGE} offer more flexibility. The detailed handling of
2087 form feeds set in the input files requires the @option{-T} option.
2090 Capital letter options override small letter ones.
2093 Some of the option-arguments (compare @option{-s}, @option{-e},
2094 @option{-i}, @option{-n}) cannot be specified as separate arguments from the
2095 preceding option letter (already stated in the @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2098 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2102 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2103 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2104 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain `:'
2105 @c The `info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2106 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2107 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2108 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2109 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2110 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2111 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2112 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2113 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2114 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2115 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2116 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2120 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2121 @opindex -@var{column}
2123 @cindex down columns
2124 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2125 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2126 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2127 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2128 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2129 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2130 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2131 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2132 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2133 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2134 with @option{-m} option.
2140 @cindex across columns
2141 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2142 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2143 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2146 @itemx --show-control-chars
2148 @opindex --show-control-chars
2149 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2150 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2151 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2154 @itemx --double-space
2156 @opindex --double-space
2157 @cindex double spacing
2158 Double space the output.
2160 @item -D @var{format}
2161 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2162 @cindex time formats
2163 @cindex formatting times
2164 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2165 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}; @xref{date invocation}.
2166 Except for directives, which start with
2167 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2168 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2169 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2171 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2174 format defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example, @samp{2001-12-04
2175 23:59}); but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2176 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the @acronym{POSIX}
2177 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2178 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2181 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2182 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2183 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2184 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
2186 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2187 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2189 @opindex --expand-tabs
2191 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2192 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2193 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2201 @opindex --form-feed
2202 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2203 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2205 @item -h @var{HEADER}
2206 @itemx --header=@var{HEADER}
2209 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2210 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2211 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2213 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2214 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2216 @opindex --output-tabs
2218 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2219 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2220 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2226 @opindex --join-lines
2227 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2228 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2229 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2230 no column alignment used; may be used with
2231 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2232 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2233 to disentangle the old (@acronym{POSIX}-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2234 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2237 @item -l @var{page_length}
2238 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2241 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2242 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2243 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2244 @option{-t} option had been given.
2250 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2251 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2252 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2254 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2255 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2256 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2257 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2258 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2259 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2260 the middle blank part.
2262 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2263 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2265 @opindex --number-lines
2266 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2267 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2268 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2269 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2270 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2271 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2272 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2273 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2274 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2275 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2276 printed with single column output only. The @var{TAB}-width varies
2277 with the @var{TAB}-position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2278 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2279 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2280 The @var{TAB}-width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2281 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2282 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2283 @var{number-separator tab}. The tabification depends upon the output
2286 @item -N @var{line_number}
2287 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2289 @opindex --first-line-number
2290 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2291 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2293 @item -o @var{margin}
2294 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2297 @cindex indenting lines
2299 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2300 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2301 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2302 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2305 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2307 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2308 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2309 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2311 @item -s[@var{char}]
2312 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2314 @opindex --separator
2315 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2316 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2317 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2318 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2319 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2320 @option{-w} is set. This is a @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2323 @item -S@var{string}
2324 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2326 @opindex --sep-string
2327 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2328 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2329 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2330 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2332 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2333 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}). @option{--sep-string} with no
2334 @samp{=@var{string}} is equivalent to @option{--sep-string=""}.
2337 @itemx --omit-header
2339 @opindex --omit-header
2340 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2341 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2342 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2343 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2344 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2345 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2346 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2349 @itemx --omit-pagination
2351 @opindex --omit-pagination
2352 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2353 set in the input files.
2356 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2358 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2359 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2361 @item -w @var{page_width}
2362 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2365 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2366 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). @option{-s[CHAR]} turns
2367 off the default page width and any line truncation and column alignment.
2368 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2369 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2370 A @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2372 @item -W @var{page_width}
2373 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2375 @opindex --page_width
2376 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters. That's valid with and
2377 without a column option. Text lines are truncated, unless @option{-J}
2378 is used. Together with one of the three column options
2379 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2380 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2381 don't affect the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2382 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2383 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2384 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}. The header
2385 line is never truncated.
2392 @node fold invocation
2393 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2396 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2397 @cindex folding long input lines
2399 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2400 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2404 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2407 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2408 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2410 @cindex screen columns
2411 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2412 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2413 return sets the column to zero.
2415 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2423 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2424 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2431 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2432 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2433 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2435 @item -w @var{width}
2436 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2439 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2441 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2442 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2450 @node Output of parts of files
2451 @chapter Output of parts of files
2453 @cindex output of parts of files
2454 @cindex parts of files, output of
2456 These commands output pieces of the input.
2459 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2460 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2461 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
2462 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2465 @node head invocation
2466 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2469 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2470 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2472 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2473 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2474 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2477 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2480 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2481 one-line header consisting of:
2484 ==> @var{file name} <==
2488 before the output for each @var{file}.
2490 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2495 @itemx --bytes=@var{n}
2498 Print the first @var{n} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2499 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2500 print all but the last @var{n} bytes of each file.
2501 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{n} by 512,
2502 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2503 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2504 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2505 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2508 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2511 Output the first @var{n} lines.
2512 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2513 print all but the last @var{n} lines of each file.
2514 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2522 Never print file name headers.
2528 Always print file name headers.
2532 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2533 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2534 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2535 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2536 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2537 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2538 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2539 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2540 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2546 @node tail invocation
2547 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2550 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2552 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2553 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2554 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2557 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2560 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2561 one-line header consisting of:
2564 ==> @var{file name} <==
2568 before the output for each @var{file}.
2570 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2571 @sc{gnu} @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2572 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2573 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2574 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2575 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2576 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2577 the @sc{gnu} @command{tac} command.
2579 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2583 @item -c @var{bytes}
2584 @itemx --bytes=@var{bytes}
2587 Output the last @var{bytes} bytes, instead of final lines.
2588 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2589 @var{n}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2590 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
2591 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2592 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2593 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2594 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2597 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2600 @cindex growing files
2601 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2602 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2603 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2604 presumably because the file is growing.
2605 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2606 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2609 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2610 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2612 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2613 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2614 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2615 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2616 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file by reopening it periodically
2617 to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2619 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2620 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2621 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2623 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2624 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2625 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2626 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2627 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2628 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2629 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2630 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2633 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2634 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2636 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2637 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, the @option{-f} option is ignored if
2638 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2642 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2643 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2644 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2648 This option is useful mainly when following by name (i.e., with
2649 @option{--follow=name}).
2650 Without this option, when tail encounters a file that doesn't
2651 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2652 never checks it again.
2654 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2655 @opindex --sleep-interval
2656 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2657 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2659 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2660 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2661 an arbitrary floating point number (using a period before any
2664 @itemx --pid=@var{pid}
2666 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2667 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2668 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2669 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2670 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2671 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2672 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2673 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2677 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2680 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2681 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2682 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2683 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2684 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2685 will print a warning if this is the case.
2687 @itemx --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2688 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2689 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2690 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2691 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2692 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2693 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2694 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2695 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2696 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
2697 This option is meaningful only when following by name.
2700 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2703 Output the last @var{n} lines.
2704 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2705 @var{n}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2706 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2714 Never print file name headers.
2720 Always print file name headers.
2724 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
2725 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
2726 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
2727 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
2728 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
2729 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
2730 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
2731 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
2733 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
2734 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
2735 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
2736 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
2737 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
2738 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
2741 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
2742 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
2743 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
2744 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
2745 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
2746 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
2747 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
2748 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
2750 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
2751 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the @acronym{POSIX}
2752 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
2753 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
2754 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
2755 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
2756 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
2761 @node split invocation
2762 @section @command{split}: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
2765 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
2766 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
2768 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive sections of
2769 @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input} is
2770 @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2773 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
2776 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
2777 left over for the last section), into each output file.
2779 @cindex output file name prefix
2780 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
2781 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
2782 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
2783 sorted order by file name produces
2784 the original input file. If the output file names are exhausted,
2785 @command{split} reports an error without deleting the output files
2788 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2792 @item -l @var{lines}
2793 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
2796 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
2798 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
2799 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use @option{-l
2800 @var{lines}} instead.
2803 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
2806 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
2807 @var{size} is a number which may be followed by one of these
2808 multiplicative suffixes:
2810 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
2811 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
2812 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
2813 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
2814 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
2816 and so on for @samp{G}, @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2819 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
2821 @opindex --line-bytes
2822 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
2823 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines longer than
2824 @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
2825 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
2827 @item -a @var{length}
2828 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
2830 @opindex --suffix-length
2831 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. The default @var{length} is 2.
2834 @itemx --numeric-suffixes
2836 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
2837 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters.
2841 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
2848 @node csplit invocation
2849 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
2852 @cindex context splitting
2853 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
2855 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
2856 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2859 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
2862 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
2863 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
2864 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
2865 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
2866 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
2869 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
2870 output file after it has been created.
2872 The types of pattern arguments are:
2877 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
2878 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
2879 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
2880 file once for each repeat.
2882 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
2883 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
2884 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
2885 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
2886 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
2887 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
2888 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
2890 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
2891 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
2892 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
2894 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
2895 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
2896 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
2897 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
2902 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
2903 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
2904 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
2905 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
2906 original input file.
2908 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
2909 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
2910 that it has created so far before it exits.
2912 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2916 @item -f @var{prefix}
2917 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2920 @cindex output file name prefix
2921 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
2923 @item -b @var{suffix}
2924 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
2927 @cindex output file name suffix
2928 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
2929 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
2930 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
2931 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
2932 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
2933 binary integer argument to readable form; thus, only @samp{d}, @samp{i},
2934 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
2935 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
2936 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
2937 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
2938 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
2940 @item -n @var{digits}
2941 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
2944 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
2945 long instead of the default 2.
2950 @opindex --keep-files
2951 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
2954 @itemx --elide-empty-files
2956 @opindex --elide-empty-files
2957 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
2958 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
2959 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
2960 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
2961 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
2972 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
2979 @node Summarizing files
2980 @chapter Summarizing files
2982 @cindex summarizing files
2984 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
2988 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
2989 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
2990 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
2991 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
2992 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
2993 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
2998 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3002 @cindex character count
3006 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3007 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3008 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3011 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3014 @cindex total counts
3015 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3016 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3017 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3018 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3019 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3020 maximum line length.
3021 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3022 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3023 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3024 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3025 However, as a @acronym{GNU} extension, if only one count is printed,
3026 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3028 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3029 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3030 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3037 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3039 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3040 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3041 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths.
3043 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3051 Print only the byte counts.
3057 Print only the character counts.
3063 Print only the word counts.
3069 Print only the newline counts.
3072 @itemx --max-line-length
3074 @opindex --max-line-length
3075 Print only the maximum line lengths.
3077 @itemx --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3078 @opindex --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3079 @cindex including files from @command{du}
3080 Rather than processing files named on the command line, process those
3081 named in file @var{FILE}; each name is terminated by a null byte.
3083 the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3085 In such cases, running @command{wc} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3086 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{wc} print a
3087 total for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3088 One way to produce a list of null-byte-terminated file names is with @sc{gnu}
3089 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate. For example, to find
3090 the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or @file{.h} file in the
3091 current hierarchy, do this:
3094 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 | wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3097 Do not specify any @var{FILE} on the command line when using this option.
3104 @node sum invocation
3105 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3108 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3109 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3111 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3112 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3115 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3118 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3119 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3120 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3121 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3122 at least one file argument.)
3124 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3125 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3128 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3134 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3135 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3136 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3137 given, it has no effect.
3143 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3144 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3145 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3149 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3150 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3155 @node cksum invocation
3156 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3159 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3160 @cindex CRC checksum
3162 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3163 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3164 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3167 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3170 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3171 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3173 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3174 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3175 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3176 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3179 The CRC algorithm is specified by the @acronym{POSIX} standard. It is not
3180 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3181 previous section); it is more robust.
3183 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3189 @node md5sum invocation
3190 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3194 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3195 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3196 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3197 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3199 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3200 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3202 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3203 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3204 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3205 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered truly
3206 secure against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a
3207 given MD5 fingerprint, or modifying a file so as to retain its MD5 are
3208 considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how to produce
3209 different files with identical MD5 (a ``collision''), something which
3210 can be a security issue in certain contexts. For more secure hashes,
3211 consider using SHA-1 or SHA-2. @xref{sha1sum invocation}, and
3212 @ref{sha2 utilities}.
3214 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3215 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3216 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3217 consistent. Synopsis:
3220 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3223 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs the MD5 checksum, a flag
3224 indicating a binary or text input file, and the file name.
3225 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3226 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3227 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3228 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3229 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3231 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3239 @cindex binary input files
3240 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3241 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3242 On systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not distinguish between binary
3243 and text files, this option merely flags each input file as binary:
3244 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3245 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3246 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3250 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3251 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3252 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3253 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3254 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3255 Each valid line of input consists of an MD5 checksum, a binary/text
3256 flag, and then a file name.
3257 Binary files are marked with @samp{*}, text with @samp{ }.
3258 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3259 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3260 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3261 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3262 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3263 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3264 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3265 a warning is issued to standard error.
3266 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3267 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3268 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3269 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3270 it exits successfully.
3274 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3275 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3276 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3277 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3278 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3280 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3281 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3282 indicating there was a failure.
3288 @cindex text input files
3289 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3290 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3291 This option is the default on systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not
3292 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3293 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3300 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3301 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3302 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3310 @node sha1sum invocation
3311 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3315 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3316 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3317 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3318 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3320 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3321 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3322 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3324 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3325 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3326 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3327 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3328 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3329 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3332 @node sha2 utilities
3333 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3340 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3341 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3342 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3343 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3344 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3345 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3346 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3347 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3348 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3349 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3350 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3351 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3352 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3353 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3354 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3355 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3357 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3358 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3359 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3360 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3361 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}.
3362 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3364 Note: The SHA384 and SHA512 digests are considerably slower to
3365 compute, especially on 32-bit computers, than SHA224 or SHA256.
3368 @node Operating on sorted files
3369 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3371 @cindex operating on sorted files
3372 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3374 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3377 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3378 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3379 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3380 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3381 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3382 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3383 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
3387 @node sort invocation
3388 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3391 @cindex sorting files
3393 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3394 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3395 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3399 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3402 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3403 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3410 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3413 @cindex checking for sortedness
3414 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
3415 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
3416 exit with a status of 1.
3417 Otherwise, exit successfully.
3418 At most one input file can be given.
3421 @itemx --check=quiet
3422 @itemx --check=silent
3425 @cindex checking for sortedness
3426 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
3427 exit with status 1 otherwise.
3428 At most one input file can be given.
3429 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
3435 @cindex merging sorted files
3436 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
3437 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
3438 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
3443 @cindex sort stability
3444 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3445 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
3446 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
3447 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
3448 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
3449 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
3450 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
3451 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
3452 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
3453 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
3454 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
3455 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
3456 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
3460 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
3461 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
3462 use a non-@acronym{POSIX} locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
3463 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
3464 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
3465 environment variable to @samp{C}. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
3466 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
3467 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
3468 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
3469 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
3470 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
3472 @sc{gnu} @command{sort} (as specified for all @sc{gnu} utilities) has no
3473 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
3474 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, @sc{gnu}
3475 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
3476 part of the line for comparison purposes.
3478 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
3482 0 if no error occurred
3483 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
3484 2 if an error occurred
3488 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
3489 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
3490 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
3491 the environment variable.
3493 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
3494 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
3495 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
3496 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
3497 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-@acronym{POSIX}
3498 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
3499 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
3504 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
3506 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
3507 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
3509 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
3510 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3514 @itemx --dictionary-order
3516 @opindex --dictionary-order
3517 @cindex dictionary order
3518 @cindex phone directory order
3519 @cindex telephone directory order
3521 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
3522 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
3523 By default letters and digits are those of @acronym{ASCII} and a blank
3524 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
3527 @itemx --ignore-case
3529 @opindex --ignore-case
3530 @cindex ignoring case
3531 @cindex case folding
3533 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
3534 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
3535 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3538 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
3539 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
3541 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
3543 @cindex general numeric sort
3545 Sort numerically, using the standard C function @code{strtod} to convert
3546 a prefix of each line to a double-precision floating point number.
3547 This allows floating point numbers to be specified in scientific notation,
3548 like @code{1.0e-34} and @code{10e100}.
3549 The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point character.
3550 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
3551 Use the following collating sequence:
3555 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
3557 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
3558 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
3562 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
3567 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
3568 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
3569 converting to floating point.
3572 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
3574 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
3575 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
3576 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
3578 Ignore nonprinting characters.
3579 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3580 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
3581 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
3587 @opindex --month-sort
3589 @cindex months, sorting by
3591 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
3592 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
3593 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}.
3594 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
3595 category determines the month spellings.
3596 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3600 @itemx --numeric-sort
3601 @itemx --sort=numeric
3603 @opindex --numeric-sort
3605 @cindex numeric sort
3607 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
3608 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
3609 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
3610 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
3611 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
3612 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
3613 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3616 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
3618 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
3619 To compare such strings numerically, use the
3620 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
3626 @cindex reverse sorting
3627 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
3628 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
3631 @itemx --random-sort
3632 @itemx --sort=random
3634 @opindex --random-sort
3637 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
3638 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
3639 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
3640 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
3641 except that keys with the same value sort together.
3643 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
3644 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
3645 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
3648 The choice of hash function is affected by the
3649 @option{--random-source} option.
3657 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
3658 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
3660 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
3661 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
3662 standard input to standard output.
3664 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
3666 Whitespace and the backslash character should not appear in
3667 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
3669 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3670 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3674 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
3675 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
3676 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
3678 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
3679 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
3680 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
3681 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
3682 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
3683 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
3684 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
3685 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
3686 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
3689 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
3690 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more examples.
3692 @item -o @var{output-file}
3693 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
3696 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
3697 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
3698 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
3699 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
3700 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}.
3701 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
3702 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
3703 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
3704 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
3706 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3707 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
3708 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}. Portable
3709 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
3712 @item --random-source=@var{file}
3713 @opindex --random-source
3714 @cindex random source for sorting
3715 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
3716 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
3723 @cindex sort stability
3724 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3726 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
3727 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
3728 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
3731 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
3733 @opindex --buffer-size
3734 @cindex size for main memory sorting
3735 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
3736 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
3737 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
3738 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
3739 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
3740 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}. Appending
3741 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
3744 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
3745 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
3746 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
3747 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
3750 @item -t @var{separator}
3751 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
3753 @opindex --field-separator
3754 @cindex field separator character
3755 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
3756 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
3757 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
3758 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3761 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
3762 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
3763 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
3764 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
3765 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
3766 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
3767 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
3768 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
3770 To specify a null character (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) as
3771 the field separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g.,
3772 @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
3774 @item -T @var{tempdir}
3775 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
3777 @opindex --temporary-directory
3778 @cindex temporary directory
3780 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
3781 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
3782 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
3783 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
3784 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
3785 disks and controllers.
3791 @cindex uniquifying output
3793 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
3794 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
3795 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
3797 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
3799 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
3800 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
3801 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
3802 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
3803 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
3806 @itemx --zero-terminated
3808 @opindex --zero-terminated
3809 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
3810 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
3811 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
3812 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
3813 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
3814 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
3815 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
3816 or other special characters).
3820 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
3821 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
3822 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}. @sc{gnu} sort follows the @acronym{POSIX}
3823 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
3824 According to @acronym{POSIX}, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
3825 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
3826 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
3827 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
3829 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
3830 of the option letters @samp{Mbdfinr} appended to it, in which case the
3831 global ordering options are not used for that particular field. The
3832 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
3833 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
3834 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
3835 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
3836 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b},
3837 @option{-g}, @option{-M}, or @option{-n}; otherwise the varying
3838 numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
3840 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
3841 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
3842 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
3843 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
3845 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3846 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3847 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
3848 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
3849 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
3850 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3851 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
3852 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
3854 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
3855 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
3856 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
3857 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
3858 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
3859 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
3862 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
3867 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
3874 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
3875 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
3876 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
3877 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
3878 and extending to the end of each line.
3885 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
3886 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
3887 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
3890 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
3893 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
3894 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
3895 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
3896 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
3897 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
3899 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
3900 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
3901 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
3902 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
3903 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
3904 field-end part of the key specifier.
3907 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
3908 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
3909 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
3913 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
3914 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
3915 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
3918 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
3919 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
3920 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
3921 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
3922 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
3923 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
3924 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
3928 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
3929 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
3930 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
3931 files contain lines that look like this:
3934 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
3935 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
3938 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
3939 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
3940 because 61 is less than 129.
3943 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
3944 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
3947 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
3948 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
3949 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
3950 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
3951 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
3952 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
3953 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
3954 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
3955 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
3956 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
3957 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
3958 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
3962 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
3965 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
3968 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
3969 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
3971 by the sort operation.
3973 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
3975 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
3976 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
3977 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
3980 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n'|perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g'|sort -z|perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
3984 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
3985 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
3986 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
3990 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
3996 @node shuf invocation
3997 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4000 @cindex shuffling files
4002 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4003 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4007 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4008 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4009 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4012 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4013 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4014 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4022 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4023 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4025 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4026 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4028 @opindex --input-range
4029 @cindex input range to shuffle
4030 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4031 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4035 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4040 @item -n @var{lines}
4041 @itemx --head-lines=@var{lines}
4043 @opindex --head-lines
4044 @cindex head of output
4045 Output at most @var{lines} lines. By default, all input lines are
4048 @item -o @var{output-file}
4049 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4052 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4053 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4054 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4055 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4056 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4058 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4059 @opindex --random-source
4060 @cindex random source for shuffling
4061 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4062 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4065 @itemx --zero-terminated
4067 @opindex --zero-terminated
4068 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4069 Treat the input and output as a set of lines, each terminated by a zero byte
4070 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (Null) character) instead of an
4071 @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed).
4072 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
4073 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4074 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4075 or other special characters).
4091 might produce the output
4101 Similarly, the command:
4104 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4118 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4128 These examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4129 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4130 general, if there are @var{N} input lines, there are @var{N}! (i.e.,
4131 @var{N} factorial, or @var{N} * (@var{N} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4132 output permutations.
4137 @node uniq invocation
4138 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4141 @cindex uniquify files
4143 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4144 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4148 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4151 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4152 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4153 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4154 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4156 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4157 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4158 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4159 @xref{sort invocation}.
4162 Comparisons use the character collating sequence specified by the
4163 @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category.
4165 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4168 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4173 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4175 @opindex --skip-fields
4176 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4177 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4178 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4179 each other by at least one space or tab.
4181 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4182 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4185 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4187 @opindex --skip-chars
4188 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4189 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4190 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4192 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4193 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4195 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4196 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4197 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4198 behavior depends on this variable.
4199 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4200 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4206 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4209 @itemx --ignore-case
4211 @opindex --ignore-case
4212 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4218 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4219 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4220 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4224 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4226 @opindex --all-repeated
4227 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4228 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4229 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4230 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4231 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4232 The optional @var{delimit-method} tells how to delimit
4233 groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the following:
4238 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4239 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4242 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4243 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4244 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4247 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4248 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4249 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4250 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4251 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4252 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4255 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4256 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4257 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\n'} to replace
4258 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4260 This is a @sc{gnu} extension.
4261 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4267 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4268 Discard the first repeated line. When used by itself, this option
4269 causes @command{uniq} to print unique lines, and nothing else.
4272 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
4274 @opindex --check-chars
4275 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
4276 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
4280 @itemx --zero-terminated
4282 @opindex --zero-terminated
4283 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4284 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
4285 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
4286 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
4287 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{sort -z}, @samp{perl -0} or
4288 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4289 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4290 or other special characters).
4297 @node comm invocation
4298 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
4301 @cindex line-by-line comparison
4302 @cindex comparing sorted files
4304 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
4305 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
4306 standard input. Synopsis:
4309 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
4313 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
4314 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
4315 If an input file ends in a non-newline
4316 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
4317 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
4319 @cindex differing lines
4320 @cindex common lines
4321 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
4322 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
4323 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
4324 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
4325 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
4326 @c string, append `by default' to the above sentence.
4331 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
4332 the corresponding columns. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4334 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
4335 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
4336 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
4337 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
4340 @node tsort invocation
4341 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
4344 @cindex topological sort
4346 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
4347 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
4348 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
4352 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
4355 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
4356 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
4357 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
4371 will produce the output
4382 Consider a more realistic example.
4383 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
4384 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
4385 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
4386 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
4387 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
4388 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
4389 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
4390 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
4391 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
4392 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
4393 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
4394 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
4400 tail_file pretty_name
4401 tail_file write_header
4403 tail_forever recheck
4404 tail_forever pretty_name
4405 tail_forever write_header
4406 tail_forever dump_remainder
4409 tail_lines start_lines
4410 tail_lines dump_remainder
4411 tail_lines file_lines
4412 tail_lines pipe_lines
4414 tail_bytes start_bytes
4415 tail_bytes dump_remainder
4416 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
4417 file_lines dump_remainder
4421 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
4422 functions that satisfies your requirement.
4425 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
4445 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
4446 encountered to standard error.
4448 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
4449 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
4450 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
4451 precedes @code{main}.
4453 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
4456 @node tsort background
4457 @section @command{tsort}: Background
4459 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
4460 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
4461 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
4462 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
4465 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
4466 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
4467 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
4468 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
4469 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
4470 reference to @code{read}.
4472 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
4473 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
4474 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
4475 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
4478 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
4479 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
4481 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
4482 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
4483 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
4484 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
4487 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
4488 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
4494 @node ptx invocation
4495 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
4499 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
4500 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
4503 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
4504 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4507 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
4508 all @sc{gnu} extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
4509 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
4510 When @option{-G} is not specified, @sc{gnu} extensions are always enabled.
4511 @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
4512 document. For the full list, see @xref{Compatibility in ptx}.
4514 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
4516 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
4517 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
4518 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
4519 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
4520 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
4521 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
4522 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
4523 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
4526 When @sc{gnu} extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
4527 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
4528 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
4529 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
4530 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
4531 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
4532 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
4533 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
4534 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
4535 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
4536 compatibility; @sc{gnu} Standards normally discourage output parameters not
4537 introduced by an option.
4539 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
4540 input text file, a single dash @kbd{-} may be used, in which case
4541 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
4542 convention more than once per program invocation.
4545 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
4546 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
4547 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
4548 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
4549 * Compatibility in ptx::
4553 @node General options in ptx
4554 @subsection General options
4559 @itemx --traditional
4560 As already explained, this option disables all @sc{gnu} extensions to
4561 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
4564 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
4568 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
4576 @node Charset selection in ptx
4577 @subsection Charset selection
4579 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
4580 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
4581 using 8-bit @acronym{ISO} 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
4582 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
4583 character set of the IBM-PC@. (@sc{gnu} @command{ptx} is not known to work on
4584 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit @acronym{ASCII}, the set
4585 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
4586 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
4587 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
4588 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
4594 @itemx --ignore-case
4595 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
4600 @node Input processing in ptx
4601 @subsection Word selection and input processing
4606 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
4608 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
4609 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
4610 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
4611 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
4612 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
4613 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
4614 @option{-b} is ignored.
4616 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
4617 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
4618 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When @sc{gnu} extensions
4619 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
4620 characters even if not included in the Break file.
4623 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
4625 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4626 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
4627 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
4628 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
4632 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
4634 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4635 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
4636 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
4637 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
4638 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
4640 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
4641 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
4642 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
4647 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
4648 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
4649 line in the resulting permuted index. For more information about reference
4650 production, see @xref{Output formatting in ptx}.
4651 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
4653 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
4654 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
4655 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
4656 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when @sc{gnu} extensions
4657 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
4658 excluded from the output contexts.
4660 @item -S @var{regexp}
4661 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
4663 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
4664 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
4665 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
4666 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
4667 default, when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
4668 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
4669 imported from @sc{gnu} Emacs:
4672 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
4675 Whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
4676 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
4682 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
4683 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
4684 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
4685 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
4686 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4689 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
4690 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
4691 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
4692 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
4693 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
4694 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
4695 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
4696 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
4697 on the right of the output line.
4699 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4700 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
4701 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4703 @item -W @var{regexp}
4704 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
4706 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
4707 By default, if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
4708 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When @sc{gnu} extensions are
4709 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
4710 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
4712 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
4713 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4716 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4717 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4718 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4723 @node Output formatting in ptx
4724 @subsection Output formatting
4726 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
4727 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
4728 selected, and if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
4729 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
4730 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
4731 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
4732 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
4733 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
4734 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
4735 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with @sc{gnu}
4736 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
4737 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
4738 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
4739 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
4740 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
4741 characters is transmitted verbatim.
4743 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
4747 @item -g @var{number}
4748 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
4750 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
4753 @item -w @var{number}
4754 @itemx --width=@var{number}
4756 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
4757 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
4758 depending on the value of option @option{-R}. If this option is not
4759 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
4760 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
4761 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
4762 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
4763 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
4767 @itemx --auto-reference
4769 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
4770 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
4771 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
4772 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
4773 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
4774 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
4777 @itemx --right-side-refs
4779 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
4780 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
4781 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
4782 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
4783 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
4784 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
4785 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
4786 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
4788 This option is automatically selected whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are
4791 @item -F @var{string}
4792 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
4794 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
4795 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
4796 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
4797 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}. But there is a maximum
4798 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
4799 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
4800 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
4801 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
4802 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
4804 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F ...}.
4805 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
4806 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
4809 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4810 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4811 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4813 @item -M @var{string}
4814 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
4816 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
4817 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
4820 @itemx --format=roff
4822 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
4823 processing. Each output line will look like:
4826 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}" "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
4829 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
4830 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when @sc{gnu}
4831 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
4832 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
4834 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
4835 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
4836 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character: @kbd{"} is doubled
4837 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
4842 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
4843 line will look like:
4846 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
4850 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
4851 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
4852 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
4853 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
4854 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
4857 In this output format, some special characters, like @kbd{$}, @kbd{%},
4858 @kbd{&}, @kbd{#} and @kbd{_} are automatically protected with a
4859 backslash. Curly brackets @kbd{@{}, @kbd{@}} are protected with a
4860 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
4861 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
4862 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
4863 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
4864 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
4865 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
4866 and all other characters which are not part of @acronym{ASCII}, are merely
4867 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
4868 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
4869 processing for @TeX{}.
4874 @node Compatibility in ptx
4875 @subsection The @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx}
4877 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
4878 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
4879 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
4880 options. Some @sc{gnu} extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
4881 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about @sc{gnu} extensions.
4882 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
4887 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
4888 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
4889 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
4890 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
4893 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
4894 practice which @sc{gnu} avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
4895 portably between @sc{gnu} and System V, you should always use it with a
4896 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
4897 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
4898 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
4899 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
4902 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
4903 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
4904 @option{-w}. All other options are @sc{gnu} extensions and are not repeated in
4905 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
4906 meaning when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, as explained below.
4909 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
4910 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
4911 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
4914 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
4915 subtracted from the total output line width. With @sc{gnu} extensions
4916 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
4917 line width computations.
4920 All 256 bytes, even null bytes, are always read and processed from
4921 input file with no adverse effect, even if @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled.
4922 However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit characters, a few
4923 control characters are rejected, and the tilde @kbd{~} is also rejected.
4926 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if @sc{gnu}
4927 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
4928 the first 200 characters in each line.
4931 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
4932 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When @sc{gnu}
4933 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
4937 The program makes better use of output line width. If @sc{gnu} extensions
4938 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
4939 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
4940 not completely reproduce.
4943 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
4944 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
4949 @node Operating on fields within a line
4950 @chapter Operating on fields within a line
4953 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
4954 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
4955 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
4959 @node cut invocation
4960 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
4963 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
4964 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
4968 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4971 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
4972 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
4973 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
4974 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
4975 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
4976 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
4977 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
4978 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
4979 is written exactly once.
4981 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
4986 @item -b @var{byte-list}
4987 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
4990 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
4991 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
4992 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
4993 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
4994 string between ranges of selected bytes.
4996 @item -c @var{character-list}
4997 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
4999 @opindex --characters
5000 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5001 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5002 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5003 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5004 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5005 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5008 @item -f @var{field-list}
5009 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5012 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5013 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5014 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5015 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified
5017 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5018 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5020 @opindex --delimiter
5021 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5022 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5026 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5029 @itemx --only-delimited
5031 @opindex --only-delimited
5032 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5033 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5035 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5036 @opindex --output-delimiter
5037 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5038 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5039 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5040 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5041 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5042 ranges of selected bytes.
5045 @opindex --complement
5046 This option is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
5047 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5048 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5049 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5050 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5051 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5058 @node paste invocation
5059 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5062 @cindex merging files
5064 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5065 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5066 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5088 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5091 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5099 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5100 file. Using the above example data:
5103 $ paste -s num2 let3
5108 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5109 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5111 @opindex --delimiters
5112 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5113 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5114 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5117 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5128 @node join invocation
5129 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5132 @cindex common field, joining on
5134 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5135 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5138 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5141 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5142 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5143 sorted on the join fields.
5146 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5147 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5148 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5149 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5150 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5151 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5153 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5154 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5155 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5156 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5157 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5158 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5160 If the input has no unpairable lines, a @acronym{GNU} extension is
5161 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
5162 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
5163 considers them to be equal. For example:
5180 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5181 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5182 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If
5183 neither of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5184 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable lines. If an
5185 input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{join} command
5186 will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5188 Forcing @command{join} to process wrongly sorted input files
5189 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5190 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5191 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5195 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
5196 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
5197 blanks on the line ignored;
5198 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
5199 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
5200 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
5203 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5207 @item -a @var{file-number}
5209 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
5210 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
5213 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5215 @item --nocheck-order
5216 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
5218 @item -e @var{string}
5220 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with
5224 @itemx --ignore-case
5226 @opindex --ignore-case
5227 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
5228 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
5229 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
5231 @item -1 @var{field}
5233 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
5235 @item -2 @var{field}
5237 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
5239 @item -j @var{field}
5240 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
5242 @item -o @var{field-list}
5243 Construct each output line according to the format in @var{field-list}.
5244 Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single character @samp{0} or
5245 has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m}, is @samp{1} or
5246 @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
5248 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
5249 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
5250 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
5251 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
5252 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
5253 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
5254 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
5255 To give @command{join} that functionality, @acronym{POSIX} invented the @samp{0}
5256 field specification notation.
5258 The elements in @var{field-list}
5259 are separated by commas or blanks.
5260 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
5261 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
5262 2.2'} are equivalent.
5264 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
5265 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
5268 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
5269 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
5270 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
5271 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering.
5273 @item -v @var{file-number}
5274 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
5275 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
5282 @node Operating on characters
5283 @chapter Operating on characters
5285 @cindex operating on characters
5287 This commands operate on individual characters.
5290 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
5291 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
5292 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
5297 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
5304 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
5307 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
5308 one of the following operations:
5312 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
5314 squeeze repeated characters,
5318 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
5321 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
5322 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
5323 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
5324 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
5326 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
5328 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
5329 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
5330 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
5331 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
5332 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
5333 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
5334 the input contains encoding errors.
5336 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
5337 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
5342 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
5343 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
5344 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
5348 @node Character sets
5349 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
5351 @cindex specifying sets of characters
5353 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
5354 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
5355 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
5356 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
5357 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
5358 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
5362 @item Backslash escapes
5363 @cindex backslash escapes
5365 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
5383 The character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
5389 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
5390 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
5391 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
5392 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
5397 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
5398 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
5399 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
5400 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
5402 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
5403 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
5404 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
5405 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
5406 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
5409 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
5410 portable. For example, on @acronym{EBCDIC} hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
5411 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
5412 are not contiguous as they are in @acronym{ASCII}.
5413 If you can rely on a @acronym{POSIX} compliant version of @command{tr}, then
5414 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
5415 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
5418 @item Repeated characters
5419 @cindex repeated characters
5421 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
5422 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
5423 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
5424 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
5425 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
5426 octal, otherwise in decimal.
5428 @item Character classes
5429 @cindex character classes
5431 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
5432 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
5433 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
5434 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
5435 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
5436 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
5437 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
5438 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
5439 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
5440 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
5441 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
5453 Horizontal whitespace.
5462 Printable characters, not including space.
5468 Printable characters, including space.
5471 Punctuation characters.
5474 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
5483 @item Equivalence classes
5484 @cindex equivalence classes
5486 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
5487 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
5488 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
5489 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
5490 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in @sc{gnu} @command{tr};
5491 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
5492 which is of no particular use.
5498 @subsection Translating
5500 @cindex translating characters
5502 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
5503 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
5504 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
5505 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
5506 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
5507 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
5508 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
5509 two commands are equivalent:
5516 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
5517 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
5520 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
5522 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
5526 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
5528 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
5529 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
5530 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
5532 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
5533 portable; @acronym{POSIX} says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
5534 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
5535 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
5536 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
5538 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
5539 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
5540 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
5541 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
5543 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
5547 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
5551 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
5552 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
5556 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
5557 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
5558 Assuming a @acronym{POSIX} compliant @command{tr}, here is a better way to write it:
5561 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5566 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
5568 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
5569 @cindex deleting characters
5571 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
5572 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
5574 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
5575 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
5576 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
5578 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
5579 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
5580 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5582 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
5583 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
5584 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5586 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
5591 Remove all zero bytes:
5598 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
5599 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
5600 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
5603 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5607 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
5614 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
5615 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
5616 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
5617 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
5618 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
5619 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
5620 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
5621 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
5627 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
5628 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
5633 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
5634 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
5640 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
5641 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
5642 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
5643 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
5644 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
5645 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
5646 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
5647 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
5648 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
5655 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
5661 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
5662 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
5668 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
5669 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
5674 @node expand invocation
5675 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
5678 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
5679 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
5681 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
5682 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
5683 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
5687 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5690 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
5691 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
5692 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
5693 tabs every 8 columns).
5695 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5699 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5700 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5703 @cindex tab stops, setting
5704 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
5705 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
5706 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
5707 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
5708 blanks as well as by commas.
5710 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
5711 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
5712 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
5718 @cindex initial tabs, converting
5719 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
5720 characters) on each line to spaces.
5727 @node unexpand invocation
5728 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
5732 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
5733 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
5734 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
5735 as many tab characters as needed. In the default @acronym{POSIX}
5736 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
5737 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
5740 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5743 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
5744 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
5745 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
5746 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
5749 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5753 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5754 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5757 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
5758 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
5759 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
5760 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
5761 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
5763 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
5764 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
5765 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
5766 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
5767 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
5773 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
5774 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
5781 @node Directory listing
5782 @chapter Directory listing
5784 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
5785 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
5788 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
5789 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
5790 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
5791 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
5796 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
5799 @cindex directory listing
5801 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
5802 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
5803 arbitrarily, as usual.
5805 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
5806 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
5807 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
5808 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
5809 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
5810 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
5813 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
5814 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-@acronym{POSIX}
5815 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
5816 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
5817 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
5818 If standard output is
5819 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
5820 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
5821 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
5823 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
5824 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
5825 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
5826 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
5827 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
5829 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
5834 1 minor problems (e.g., a subdirectory was not found)
5835 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted)
5838 Also see @ref{Common options}.
5841 * Which files are listed::
5842 * What information is listed::
5843 * Sorting the output::
5844 * More details about version sort::
5845 * General output formatting::
5846 * Formatting file timestamps::
5847 * Formatting the file names::
5851 @node Which files are listed
5852 @subsection Which files are listed
5854 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
5855 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
5856 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
5857 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
5865 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
5870 @opindex --almost-all
5871 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
5872 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
5873 option overrides this option.
5876 @itemx --ignore-backups
5878 @opindex --ignore-backups
5879 @cindex backup files, ignoring
5880 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
5881 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
5886 @opindex --directory
5887 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
5888 than listing their contents.
5889 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
5890 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
5891 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
5892 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
5893 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
5896 @itemx --dereference-command-line
5898 @opindex --dereference-command-line
5899 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5900 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
5901 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
5903 @itemx --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
5904 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
5905 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5906 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
5907 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
5908 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
5910 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
5911 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
5912 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
5914 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
5915 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
5917 @item --group-directories-first
5918 @opindex --group-directories-first
5919 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
5920 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
5921 (see --sort option).
5922 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
5923 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
5924 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
5925 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
5927 @item --hide=PATTERN
5928 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
5929 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
5930 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
5931 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
5932 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
5933 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
5934 (@option{-A}) is also given.
5936 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
5937 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
5938 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
5939 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
5941 @item -I @var{pattern}
5942 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
5944 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
5945 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
5946 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
5947 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
5948 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
5949 to give this option several times. For example,
5952 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
5955 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
5956 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
5957 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
5960 @itemx --dereference
5962 @opindex --dereference
5963 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5964 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
5965 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
5966 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
5967 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
5972 @opindex --recursive
5973 @cindex recursive directory listing
5974 @cindex directory listing, recursive
5975 List the contents of all directories recursively.
5980 @node What information is listed
5981 @subsection What information is listed
5983 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
5984 default, only file names are shown.
5990 @cindex hurd, author, printing
5991 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
5992 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
5993 operating systems the two are the same.
5999 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6000 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6004 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6008 The @var{begN} and @var{endN} are unsigned integers that record the
6009 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6010 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
6011 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
6013 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
6014 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
6017 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
6020 Finally, output a line of the form:
6023 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
6027 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
6029 Here is an actual example:
6032 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6034 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6035 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6038 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6039 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6040 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6041 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6045 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6049 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6053 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6054 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6055 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6058 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6059 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6061 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6062 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6064 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6065 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6068 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6069 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6073 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6074 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6075 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6076 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6077 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6082 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6083 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6085 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6088 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6089 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6090 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6091 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6092 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6093 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6094 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6097 @opindex --full-time
6098 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6099 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6100 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6104 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6110 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6111 (This is the default in some non-@sc{gnu} versions of @command{ls}, so we
6112 provide this option for compatibility.)
6120 @cindex inode number, printing
6121 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6122 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6123 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6126 @itemx --format=long
6127 @itemx --format=verbose
6130 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6131 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6132 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6133 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6134 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6135 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6136 cannot be determined.
6138 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6139 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6140 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6141 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6142 separator of the current locale.
6144 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6145 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6146 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6147 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6148 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6149 this is arguably a deficiency.
6151 The file type is one of the following characters:
6153 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6161 character special file
6163 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
6167 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
6169 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
6173 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
6175 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
6177 network special file (HP-UX)
6181 port (Solaris 10 and up)
6183 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
6187 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6189 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6191 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
6193 some other file type
6196 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
6197 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
6198 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
6199 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
6203 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
6207 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
6208 executable bit is not set.
6211 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
6212 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
6213 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
6216 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
6217 other-executable bit is not set.
6220 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
6226 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
6227 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
6228 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
6229 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
6230 character, then there is such a method.
6232 For a file with an extended access control list, a @samp{+} character is
6233 listed. Basic access control lists are equivalent to the permissions
6234 listed, and are not considered an alternate access method.
6237 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
6239 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
6240 @cindex numeric uid and gid
6241 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
6242 Produce long format directory listings, but
6243 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
6247 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
6248 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
6254 @cindex disk allocation
6255 @cindex size of files, reporting
6256 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
6257 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
6258 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
6260 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
6261 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6263 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
6264 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
6265 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
6266 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
6267 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
6268 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
6275 @node Sorting the output
6276 @subsection Sorting the output
6278 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
6279 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
6280 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
6281 (e.g., @acronym{ASCII} order).
6287 @itemx --time=status
6290 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
6291 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
6292 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6293 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
6294 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
6295 the modification time.
6296 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6297 or when not using a long listing format,
6298 sort according to the status change time.
6302 @cindex unsorted directory listing
6303 @cindex directory order, listing by
6304 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
6305 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
6306 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
6307 were specified before the @option{-f}).
6313 @cindex reverse sorting
6314 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
6315 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
6321 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
6322 Sort by file size, largest first.
6328 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
6329 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
6333 @itemx --time=access
6337 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6338 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6339 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6340 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
6341 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
6342 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6343 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
6349 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6350 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
6351 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
6352 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
6353 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
6356 @itemx --sort=version
6359 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6360 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
6361 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
6362 as an index/version number. (@xref{More details about version sort}.)
6365 @itemx --sort=extension
6368 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
6369 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
6370 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
6375 @node More details about version sort
6376 @subsection More details about version sort
6378 The version sort takes into account the fact that file names frequently include
6379 indices or version numbers. Standard sorting functions usually do not produce
6380 the ordering that people expect because comparisons are made on a
6381 character-by-character basis. The version
6382 sort addresses this problem, and is especially useful when browsing
6383 directories that contain many files with indices/version numbers in their
6388 foo.zml-1.gz foo.zml-1.gz
6389 foo.zml-100.gz foo.zml-2.gz
6390 foo.zml-12.gz foo.zml-6.gz
6391 foo.zml-13.gz foo.zml-12.gz
6392 foo.zml-2.gz foo.zml-13.gz
6393 foo.zml-25.gz foo.zml-25.gz
6394 foo.zml-6.gz foo.zml-100.gz
6397 Note also that numeric parts with leading zeros are considered as
6402 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
6403 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
6404 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
6407 This functionality is implemented using the @code{strverscmp} function.
6408 @xref{String/Array Comparison, , , libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6409 One result of that implementation decision is that @code{ls -v} does not
6410 use the locale category, @env{LC_COLLATE}. As a result, non-numeric prefixes
6411 are sorted as if @env{LC_COLLATE} were set to @code{C}.
6413 @node General output formatting
6414 @subsection General output formatting
6416 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
6421 @itemx --format=single-column
6424 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
6425 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
6426 output is not a terminal.
6429 @itemx --format=vertical
6432 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
6433 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
6434 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
6435 for the @command{dir} program.
6436 @sc{gnu} @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
6437 possible in the fewest lines.
6439 @item --color [=@var{when}]
6441 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
6442 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
6443 may be omitted, or one of:
6446 @vindex none @r{color option}
6447 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
6449 @vindex auto @r{color option}
6450 @cindex terminal, using color iff
6451 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
6453 @vindex always @r{color option}
6456 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
6457 @option{--color=always}.
6458 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
6459 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
6460 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
6464 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
6467 @opindex --indicator-style
6468 @cindex file type and executables, marking
6469 @cindex executables and file type, marking
6470 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
6471 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
6472 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
6473 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
6474 and nothing for regular files.
6475 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
6476 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6477 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6478 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6479 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6482 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
6483 @opindex --file-type
6484 @opindex --indicator-style
6485 @cindex file type, marking
6486 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
6487 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
6489 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
6490 @opindex --indicator-style
6491 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
6496 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
6498 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
6501 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
6502 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
6503 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
6505 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
6506 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
6507 @option{--classify} option.
6512 Print file sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block
6513 size (@pxref{Block size}).
6514 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
6517 @itemx --format=commas
6520 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
6521 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
6522 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
6525 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
6527 @opindex --indicator-style
6528 @cindex file type, marking
6529 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
6532 @itemx --format=across
6533 @itemx --format=horizontal
6536 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
6537 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
6538 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
6541 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
6544 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
6545 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
6546 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
6548 @c FIXME: remove in 2009, if Apple Terminal has been fixed for long enough.
6549 Some terminal emulators (at least Apple Terminal 1.5 (133) from Mac OS X 10.4.8)
6550 do not properly align columns to the right of a TAB following a
6551 non-@acronym{ASCII} byte. If you use such a terminal emulator, use the
6552 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment to tell
6553 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
6556 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
6560 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
6561 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
6562 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
6568 @node Formatting file timestamps
6569 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
6571 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form. Most
6572 locales use a timestamp like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. However, the
6573 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002}
6574 for non-recent timestamps, and a date-without-year and time like
6575 @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
6577 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
6578 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
6579 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
6580 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
6581 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
6584 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
6585 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
6586 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
6587 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
6589 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
6592 @item --time-style=@var{style}
6593 @opindex --time-style
6595 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
6596 be one of the following:
6601 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
6602 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
6603 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
6604 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
6605 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
6606 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
6608 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
6609 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
6610 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
6611 spaces in one of the two formats.
6614 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
6615 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
6616 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
6617 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
6619 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
6620 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
6621 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since @acronym{GNU} @command{make}
6622 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
6625 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
6626 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
6627 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
6628 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
6631 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
6632 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and @acronym{ISO} 8601 month, day, hour, and
6633 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
6634 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
6635 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
6636 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
6637 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6642 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
6643 ls -l --time-style="iso"
6648 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
6649 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
6650 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
6651 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
6652 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
6653 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
6655 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
6656 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
6657 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
6658 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6663 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
6664 ls -l --time-style="locale"
6667 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
6668 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
6669 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
6670 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
6671 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
6673 @item posix-@var{style}
6675 List @acronym{POSIX}-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
6676 category is @acronym{POSIX}, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
6677 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
6678 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
6679 the @acronym{POSIX} locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
6684 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
6685 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
6686 the default style is @samp{locale}. @acronym{GNU} Emacs 21.3 and
6687 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
6688 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
6689 non-@acronym{POSIX} locale you may need to set
6690 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
6692 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
6693 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
6696 @node Formatting the file names
6697 @subsection Formatting the file names
6699 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
6705 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
6708 @opindex --quoting-style
6709 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
6710 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
6711 backslash sequences like those used in C.
6715 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
6718 @opindex --quoting-style
6719 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
6720 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
6721 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
6725 @itemx --hide-control-chars
6727 @opindex --hide-control-chars
6728 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
6729 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
6734 @itemx --quoting-style=c
6736 @opindex --quote-name
6737 @opindex --quoting-style
6738 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
6741 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
6742 @opindex --quoting-style
6743 @cindex quoting style
6744 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
6745 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
6746 be one of the following:
6750 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
6751 @option{--literal} option.
6753 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
6754 cause ambiguous output.
6755 The quoting is suitable for @acronym{POSIX}-compatible shells like
6756 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
6759 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
6761 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
6762 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
6763 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
6765 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
6766 surrounding double-quote
6767 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
6769 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6770 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
6773 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
6774 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6775 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
6776 @t{`like this'} instead of @t{"like
6777 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
6780 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
6781 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. If that environment
6782 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
6783 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
6785 @item --show-control-chars
6786 @opindex --show-control-chars
6787 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
6788 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
6794 @node dir invocation
6795 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
6798 @cindex directory listing, brief
6800 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
6801 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
6802 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6804 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
6807 @node vdir invocation
6808 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
6811 @cindex directory listing, verbose
6813 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
6814 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
6815 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6817 @node dircolors invocation
6818 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
6822 @cindex setup for color
6824 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
6825 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
6829 eval "`dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]`"
6832 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
6833 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
6834 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
6835 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
6838 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
6839 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
6840 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
6841 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
6842 environment variable.
6844 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6849 @itemx --bourne-shell
6852 @opindex --bourne-shell
6853 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
6854 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
6855 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
6856 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
6865 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
6866 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
6867 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
6868 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
6871 @itemx --print-database
6873 @opindex --print-database
6874 @cindex color database, printing
6875 @cindex database for color setup, printing
6876 @cindex printing color database
6877 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
6878 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
6879 of the possibilities.
6886 @node Basic operations
6887 @chapter Basic operations
6889 @cindex manipulating files
6891 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
6892 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
6895 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
6896 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
6897 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
6898 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
6899 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
6900 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
6905 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
6908 @cindex copying files and directories
6909 @cindex files, copying
6910 @cindex directories, copying
6912 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
6913 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
6914 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
6918 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
6919 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
6920 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
6925 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
6929 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
6930 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
6931 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
6932 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
6933 using the @var{source}s' names.
6936 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
6937 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
6939 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
6940 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
6941 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
6942 to corresponding destination directories.
6944 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
6945 link only when not copying
6946 recursively. This default can be overridden with the
6947 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
6948 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
6949 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
6950 the last one silently overrides the others.
6952 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
6953 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
6954 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
6955 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
6956 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
6957 practice and to @acronym{POSIX}.
6958 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
6959 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
6960 Also, when an option like
6961 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
6962 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
6963 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
6965 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
6966 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
6967 @option{--copy-contents} option.
6969 @cindex self-backups
6970 @cindex backups, making only
6971 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
6972 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
6973 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
6974 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
6975 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
6976 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
6978 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6985 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
6986 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
6987 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
6988 directory in a different order).
6989 Equivalent to @option{-dpR}.
6992 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
6995 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
6996 @cindex backups, making
6997 @xref{Backup options}.
6998 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
6999 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
7000 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
7001 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
7002 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
7006 # Usage: backup FILE...
7007 # Create a @sc{gnu}-style backup of each listed FILE.
7009 cp --backup --force -- "$i" "$i"
7013 @item --copy-contents
7014 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7015 @cindex copying directories recursively
7016 @cindex recursively copying directories
7017 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7018 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
7019 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
7020 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
7021 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
7022 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
7023 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
7024 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
7025 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
7026 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
7027 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
7028 affect the copying of symbolic links.
7032 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7033 @cindex hard links, preserving
7034 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7035 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7036 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7042 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7043 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force}),
7044 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7045 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7046 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7047 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7048 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7050 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7051 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7055 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7056 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7057 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7058 via recursive traversal.
7061 @itemx --interactive
7063 @opindex --interactive
7064 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7065 overwrite an existing destination file.
7071 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7074 @itemx --dereference
7076 @opindex --dereference
7077 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7080 @itemx --no-dereference
7082 @opindex --no-dereference
7083 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7084 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7085 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
7086 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
7089 @itemx @w{@kbd{--preserve}[=@var{attribute_list}]}
7092 @cindex file information, preserving
7093 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
7094 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
7095 of one or more of the following strings:
7099 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
7101 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
7102 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
7104 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
7105 a member of the desired group.
7107 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
7108 In general, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
7109 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
7110 However, FreeBSD now provides the @code{lutimes} function, which makes
7111 it possible even for symbolic links. However, this implementation does
7112 not yet take advantage of that.
7113 @c FIXME: once we provide lutimes support, update the above.
7115 Preserve in the destination files
7116 any links between corresponding source files.
7117 @c Give examples illustrating how hard links are preserved.
7118 @c Also, show how soft links map to hard links with -L and -H.
7120 Preserve all file attributes.
7121 Equivalent to specifying all of the above.
7124 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
7125 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
7127 In the absence of this option, each destination file is created with the
7128 mode bits of the corresponding source file, minus the bits set in the
7129 umask and minus the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits.
7130 @xref{File permissions}.
7132 @itemx @w{@kbd{--no-preserve}=@var{attribute_list}}
7133 @cindex file information, preserving
7134 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
7135 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
7139 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
7140 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
7141 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
7142 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
7143 For example, the command:
7146 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
7150 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
7151 any missing intermediate directories.
7153 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7155 @cindex interactivity
7156 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7157 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7158 Using @option{--reply=yes} makes @command{cp} act as if @samp{yes} were
7159 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file. That effectively
7160 cancels any preceding @option{--interactive} or @option{-i} option.
7161 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{cp} act as if @samp{no} were
7162 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7163 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{cp} prompt the user
7164 about each existing destination file.
7171 @opindex --recursive
7172 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7173 @cindex copying directories recursively
7174 @cindex recursively copying directories
7175 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7176 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
7177 links in the source; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
7178 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
7179 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
7180 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
7181 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
7182 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
7183 non-@sc{gnu} systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
7184 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
7185 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
7186 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as @acronym{POSIX} allows
7187 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
7189 @item --remove-destination
7190 @opindex --remove-destination
7191 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
7192 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
7194 @item --sparse=@var{when}
7195 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
7196 @cindex sparse files, copying
7197 @cindex holes, copying files with
7198 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
7199 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
7200 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
7201 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
7202 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
7203 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
7204 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
7205 Only regular files may be sparse.
7207 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
7211 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
7212 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
7213 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
7216 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
7217 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
7218 input file does not appear to be sparse.
7219 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
7220 that does not support sparse files
7221 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
7222 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
7223 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
7224 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
7227 Never make the output file sparse.
7228 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
7229 since such a file must not have any holes.
7232 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7235 @itemx --symbolic-link
7237 @opindex --symbolic-link
7238 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
7239 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
7240 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
7241 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
7242 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
7248 @optNoTargetDirectory
7254 @cindex newer files, copying only
7255 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7256 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
7257 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
7258 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
7259 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
7260 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and
7267 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7270 @itemx --one-file-system
7272 @opindex --one-file-system
7273 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
7274 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
7275 the copy started on.
7276 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
7284 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
7287 @cindex converting while copying a file
7289 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
7290 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
7291 conversions on it. Synopses:
7294 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
7298 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
7299 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands.
7305 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
7309 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
7310 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
7311 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
7313 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
7315 @cindex block size of input
7316 @cindex input block size
7317 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
7318 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
7320 @item obs=@var{bytes}
7322 @cindex block size of output
7323 @cindex output block size
7324 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
7325 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
7327 @item bs=@var{bytes}
7330 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
7331 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
7332 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
7334 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
7336 @cindex block size of conversion
7337 @cindex conversion block size
7338 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
7339 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
7340 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
7341 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
7342 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
7343 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
7345 @item skip=@var{blocks}
7347 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
7349 @item seek=@var{blocks}
7351 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
7353 @item count=@var{blocks}
7355 Copy @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
7356 of everything until the end of the file.
7358 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
7360 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
7361 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7368 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
7369 Convert @acronym{EBCDIC} to @acronym{ASCII},
7370 using the conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7371 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
7374 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7375 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to @acronym{EBCDIC}.
7376 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
7379 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7380 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to alternate @acronym{EBCDIC},
7381 using the alternate conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7382 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
7383 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
7385 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
7389 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
7390 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
7391 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
7395 Replace trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block with a
7398 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7401 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
7402 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
7405 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
7406 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
7408 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7411 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
7412 @cindex byte-swapping
7413 Swap every pair of input bytes. @sc{gnu} @command{dd}, unlike others, works
7414 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
7415 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
7419 @cindex read errors, ignoring
7420 Continue after read errors.
7424 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
7425 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
7429 @cindex creating output file, requiring
7430 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
7433 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7437 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
7438 Do not truncate the output file.
7441 @opindex sync @r{(padding with nulls)}
7442 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
7443 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
7448 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
7449 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
7450 write of output data.
7454 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
7455 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
7456 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
7460 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7462 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7463 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7465 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7467 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7468 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7470 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
7477 @cindex appending to the output file
7478 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
7479 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
7480 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
7481 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
7482 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
7483 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
7488 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
7492 @cindex directory I/O
7494 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
7495 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
7499 @cindex synchronized data reads
7500 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
7501 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
7502 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
7503 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
7504 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
7508 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
7509 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
7513 @cindex nonblocking I/O
7514 Use non-blocking I/O.
7519 Do not update the file's access time.
7520 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
7521 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
7525 @cindex controlling terminal
7526 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
7527 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
7528 On many hosts (e.g., @acronym{GNU}/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
7533 @cindex symbolic links, following
7534 Do not follow symbolic links.
7539 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
7544 Use binary I/O. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
7545 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
7550 Use text I/O. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
7555 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
7556 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
7557 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
7558 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
7559 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
7560 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
7564 @cindex multipliers after numbers
7565 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{bytes} and @var{blocks}) can be
7566 followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
7567 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
7568 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
7570 Use different @command{dd} invocations to use different block sizes for
7571 skipping and I/O@. For example, the following shell commands copy data
7572 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save or restore a
7573 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
7576 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
7579 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
7580 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
7582 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
7583 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
7586 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal to a running @command{dd}
7587 process makes it print I/O statistics to standard error
7588 and then resume copying. In the example below,
7589 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 10 million blocks.
7590 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
7591 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
7592 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
7595 $ dd if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=10MB & pid=$!
7596 $ kill -s INFO $pid; wait $pid
7597 3385223+0 records in
7598 3385223+0 records out
7599 1733234176 bytes (1.7 GB) copied, 6.42173 seconds, 270 MB/s
7600 10000000+0 records in
7601 10000000+0 records out
7602 5120000000 bytes (5.1 GB) copied, 18.913 seconds, 271 MB/s
7605 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
7606 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
7607 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
7608 environment variable is set.
7613 @node install invocation
7614 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
7617 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
7619 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
7620 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
7623 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7624 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7625 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7626 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
7631 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
7635 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7636 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7637 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7638 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
7639 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7642 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
7643 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
7644 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
7645 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
7646 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
7647 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
7650 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
7651 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
7652 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
7653 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
7654 files onto themselves.
7656 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7664 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
7668 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
7669 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
7670 This option is ignored if a destination directory is specified
7671 via @option{--target-directory=DIR}.
7676 @opindex --directory
7677 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
7678 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
7679 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
7680 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
7681 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
7682 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
7684 @item -g @var{group}
7685 @itemx --group=@var{group}
7688 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
7689 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
7690 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
7691 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
7694 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
7697 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
7698 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
7699 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
7700 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
7701 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
7702 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
7703 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
7704 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
7705 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
7706 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
7707 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
7709 @item -o @var{owner}
7710 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
7713 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
7714 @cindex appropriate privileges
7715 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
7716 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
7717 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
7718 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
7722 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
7724 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
7725 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
7726 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
7727 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
7728 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
7729 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
7730 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
7731 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
7732 to when they were last installed.
7738 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
7739 @cindex stripping symbol table information
7740 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
7746 @optNoTargetDirectory
7752 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7760 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
7764 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
7767 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7768 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7769 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7774 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
7778 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7779 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7780 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7781 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
7782 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7785 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
7786 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
7787 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
7788 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
7789 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
7790 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
7791 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
7792 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
7793 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
7794 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
7795 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
7796 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
7799 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
7800 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
7801 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
7802 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
7803 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
7804 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7806 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
7807 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
7808 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
7809 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
7810 On modern Linux systems, it fails with @code{errno=ENOTDIR}.
7811 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
7812 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
7813 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
7815 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7825 @cindex prompts, omitting
7826 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
7829 @itemx --interactive
7831 @opindex --interactive
7832 @cindex prompts, forcing
7833 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
7835 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7837 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7839 @cindex interactivity
7840 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7841 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7842 Specifying @option{--reply=yes} is equivalent to using @option{--force}.
7843 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{mv} act as if @samp{no} were
7844 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7845 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{mv} prompt the user
7846 about each existing destination file.
7847 Note that @option{--reply=no} has an effect only when @command{mv} would prompt
7848 without @option{-i} or equivalent, i.e., when a destination file exists and is
7849 not writable, standard input is a terminal, and no @option{-f} (or equivalent)
7850 option is specified.
7856 @cindex newer files, moving only
7857 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7858 same or newer modification time.
7859 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
7860 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
7861 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
7862 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
7863 same source and destination.
7869 Print the name of each file before moving it.
7871 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7877 @optNoTargetDirectory
7885 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
7888 @cindex removing files or directories
7890 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
7891 directories. Synopsis:
7894 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7897 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
7898 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
7899 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
7900 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
7901 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
7902 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
7904 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
7905 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
7906 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
7907 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
7908 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7910 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
7911 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting.
7913 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
7914 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
7915 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
7917 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7925 Ignore nonexistent files and never prompt the user.
7926 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
7930 Prompt whether to remove each file.
7931 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7932 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
7933 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
7937 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
7938 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
7939 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
7940 @option{--interactive=once}.
7942 @itemx --interactive [=@var{when}]
7943 @opindex --interactive
7944 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
7948 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
7949 - Do not prompt at all.
7951 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
7952 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
7953 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
7955 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
7956 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
7958 Specifying @option{--interactive} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
7959 @option{--interactive=always}.
7961 @itemx --one-file-system
7962 @opindex --one-file-system
7963 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
7964 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
7965 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
7967 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
7968 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
7969 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
7970 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
7971 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
7972 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
7973 under @file{/home}, too.
7974 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
7975 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
7976 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
7977 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
7979 @itemx --preserve-root
7980 @opindex --preserve-root
7981 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
7982 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
7983 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
7984 This is the default behavior.
7985 @xref{Treating / specially}.
7987 @itemx --no-preserve-root
7988 @opindex --no-preserve-root
7989 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
7990 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
7991 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
7992 remove all the files on your computer.
7993 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8000 @opindex --recursive
8001 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
8002 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
8008 Print the name of each file before removing it.
8012 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
8013 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
8014 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
8015 @samp{-}. @sc{gnu} @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
8016 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
8017 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
8018 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
8031 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
8032 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
8033 predates the development of the getopt standard syntax.
8038 @node shred invocation
8039 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
8042 @cindex data, erasing
8043 @cindex erasing data
8045 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
8046 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
8048 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
8049 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
8050 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
8051 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
8052 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
8054 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
8055 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
8056 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
8057 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
8059 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
8060 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
8061 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
8062 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
8065 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
8066 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
8067 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
8068 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
8069 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
8071 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
8072 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
8073 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
8074 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
8075 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
8076 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
8077 from the proceedings of the Sixth @acronym{USENIX} Security Symposium (San Jose,
8078 California, July 22--25, 1996).
8080 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
8081 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
8082 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
8083 assumption. Exceptions include:
8088 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
8089 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
8090 BFS, NTFS, etc.@: when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
8093 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
8094 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
8097 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
8100 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
8104 Compressed file systems.
8107 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
8108 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
8109 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
8110 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
8111 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
8112 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
8113 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
8114 the mount man page (man mount).
8116 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
8117 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
8118 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
8120 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
8121 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
8122 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
8123 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
8124 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
8127 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
8128 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
8129 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
8130 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
8131 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
8134 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
8135 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
8136 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
8137 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
8138 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
8141 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
8144 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8152 @cindex force deletion
8153 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
8156 @itemx -n @var{NUMBER}
8157 @itemx --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8158 @opindex -n @var{NUMBER}
8159 @opindex --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8160 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
8161 By default, @command{shred} uses 25 passes of overwrite. This is enough
8162 for all of the useful overwrite patterns to be used at least once.
8163 You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you have a lot of
8166 @item --random-source=@var{file}
8167 @opindex --random-source
8168 @cindex random source for shredding
8169 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
8170 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
8172 @item -s @var{BYTES}
8173 @itemx --size=@var{BYTES}
8174 @opindex -s @var{BYTES}
8175 @opindex --size=@var{BYTES}
8176 @cindex size of file to shred
8177 Shred the first @var{BYTES} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
8178 the whole file. @var{BYTES} can be followed by a size specification like
8179 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
8185 @cindex removing files after shredding
8186 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
8187 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
8193 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
8199 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
8200 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the last block of the file.
8201 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
8202 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
8203 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
8204 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
8210 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
8211 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
8212 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
8213 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
8214 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
8215 by the @option{--iterations} option.
8219 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
8220 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
8221 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
8225 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
8228 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
8229 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
8232 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
8235 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
8236 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
8240 i=`tempfile -m 0600`
8243 echo "Hello, world" >&3
8248 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
8249 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
8250 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
8251 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
8256 @node Special file types
8257 @chapter Special file types
8259 @cindex special file types
8260 @cindex file types, special
8262 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
8263 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
8265 @cindex special file types
8267 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
8268 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
8269 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
8270 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
8271 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
8272 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
8273 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
8274 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
8276 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
8277 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
8280 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8281 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
8282 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
8283 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
8284 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
8285 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link.
8286 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
8287 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8291 @node link invocation
8292 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8295 @cindex links, creating
8296 @cindex hard links, creating
8297 @cindex creating links (hard only)
8299 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
8300 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8301 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
8302 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8303 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8304 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
8308 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
8311 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
8312 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
8313 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
8316 On a @acronym{GNU} system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
8317 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
8318 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
8319 not specified by @acronym{POSIX}, and the @command{link} command is
8320 more portable in practice.
8326 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
8329 @cindex links, creating
8330 @cindex hard links, creating
8331 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
8332 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
8334 @cindex file systems and hard links
8335 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
8336 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
8340 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
8341 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
8342 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
8343 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
8349 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
8350 file from the second.
8353 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
8354 in the current directory.
8357 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8358 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8359 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8360 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
8361 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
8365 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
8366 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
8367 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
8368 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
8371 @cindex hard link, defined
8372 @cindex inode, and hard links
8373 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
8374 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
8375 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
8376 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
8377 file. On all existing implementations, you cannot make a hard link to
8378 a directory, and hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
8379 restrictions are not mandated by @acronym{POSIX}, however.)
8381 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
8382 @cindex symbolic link, defined
8383 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
8384 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
8385 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
8386 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
8387 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
8388 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
8389 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
8390 link file itself, rather than on its target. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
8391 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8393 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8404 @opindex --directory
8405 @cindex hard links to directories
8406 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
8408 However, note that this will probably fail due to
8409 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
8415 Remove existing destination files.
8418 @itemx --interactive
8420 @opindex --interactive
8421 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
8422 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
8425 @itemx --no-dereference
8427 @opindex --no-dereference
8428 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
8429 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
8431 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
8432 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
8433 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
8434 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
8435 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
8436 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
8437 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
8438 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
8439 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
8440 just like a directory.
8442 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
8443 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
8449 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
8450 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8456 @optNoTargetDirectory
8462 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
8473 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
8474 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
8479 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
8485 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
8486 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
8490 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
8491 # work across networked file systems.
8492 ln -s afile anotherfile
8493 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
8497 @node mkdir invocation
8498 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
8501 @cindex directories, creating
8502 @cindex creating directories
8504 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
8507 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
8510 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
8511 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
8512 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
8514 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8519 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8522 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
8523 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
8524 which uses the same syntax as
8525 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
8526 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
8528 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
8529 is created. As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @var{mode} may also mention
8530 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
8531 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
8532 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8533 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
8534 overridden in this way.
8540 @cindex parent directories, creating
8541 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
8542 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
8543 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
8546 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
8547 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
8548 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
8549 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
8550 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
8551 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
8552 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
8553 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
8554 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
8560 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
8567 @node mkfifo invocation
8568 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
8571 @cindex FIFOs, creating
8572 @cindex named pipes, creating
8573 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
8575 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
8576 specified names. Synopsis:
8579 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
8582 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
8583 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
8584 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
8585 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
8587 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8592 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8595 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
8596 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8597 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
8598 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
8599 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
8606 @node mknod invocation
8607 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
8610 @cindex block special files, creating
8611 @cindex character special files, creating
8613 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
8614 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
8617 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
8620 @cindex special files
8621 @cindex block special files
8622 @cindex character special files
8623 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
8624 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
8625 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
8626 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
8627 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
8628 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
8629 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
8630 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
8632 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
8637 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
8641 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
8642 for a block special file
8645 @c Don't document the `u' option -- it's just a synonym for `c'.
8646 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
8648 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
8649 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
8650 for a character special file
8654 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
8655 device numbers must be given after the file type.
8656 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
8657 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
8658 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
8660 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8665 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8668 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8669 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
8670 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
8671 @xref{File permissions}.
8678 @node readlink invocation
8679 @section @command{readlink}: Print the referent of a symbolic link
8682 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
8684 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
8690 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic link.
8691 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
8692 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8694 @item Canonicalize mode
8696 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given file which contains
8697 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
8698 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
8703 readlink [@var{option}] @var{file}
8706 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
8708 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8713 @itemx --canonicalize
8715 @opindex --canonicalize
8716 Activate canonicalize mode.
8717 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
8718 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8721 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
8723 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
8724 Activate canonicalize mode.
8725 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
8726 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8729 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
8731 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
8732 Activate canonicalize mode.
8733 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
8739 @opindex --no-newline
8740 Do not output the trailing newline.
8750 Suppress most error messages.
8756 Report error messages.
8760 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
8765 @node rmdir invocation
8766 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
8769 @cindex removing empty directories
8770 @cindex directories, removing empty
8772 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
8775 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
8778 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
8779 directory, it is an error.
8781 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8785 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8786 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8787 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
8788 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
8789 the directory is non-empty.
8795 @cindex parent directories, removing
8796 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
8797 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
8798 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
8799 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
8800 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
8801 exit unsuccessfully.
8807 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
8808 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
8809 @var{directory} is removed.
8813 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
8818 @node unlink invocation
8819 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8822 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
8824 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
8825 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8826 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
8827 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
8828 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8829 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
8832 unlink @var{filename}
8835 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
8836 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
8837 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
8839 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
8840 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
8841 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
8846 @node Changing file attributes
8847 @chapter Changing file attributes
8849 @cindex changing file attributes
8850 @cindex file attributes, changing
8851 @cindex attributes, file
8853 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
8854 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
8855 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
8856 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
8857 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
8860 These commands change file attributes.
8863 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
8864 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
8865 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
8866 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
8870 @node chown invocation
8871 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
8874 @cindex file ownership, changing
8875 @cindex group ownership, changing
8876 @cindex changing file ownership
8877 @cindex changing group ownership
8879 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
8880 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
8884 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
8887 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
8888 (with no embedded white space):
8891 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
8898 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
8899 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
8902 @item owner@samp{:}group
8903 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
8904 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
8905 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
8908 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
8909 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
8910 @var{owner}'s login group.
8913 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
8914 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
8915 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
8918 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
8919 owner nor the group is changed.
8923 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
8924 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
8925 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
8927 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
8928 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
8929 require support for that, but for backward compatibility @acronym{GNU}
8930 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
8931 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
8932 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
8933 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
8936 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
8937 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
8938 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
8939 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
8940 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
8941 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
8942 privileges, or when the
8943 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
8945 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
8947 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8955 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
8956 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
8965 @cindex error messages, omitting
8966 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
8969 @itemx @w{@kbd{--from}=@var{old-owner}}
8971 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
8972 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
8973 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
8975 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
8976 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
8977 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
8978 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
8981 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
8984 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
8985 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
8987 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
8991 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
8994 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
8995 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
8996 though still not perfect:
8999 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
9003 @opindex --dereference
9004 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9006 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9007 This is the default.
9010 @itemx --no-dereference
9012 @opindex --no-dereference
9013 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9015 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9016 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9017 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9018 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
9020 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9021 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9023 @itemx --preserve-root
9024 @opindex --preserve-root
9025 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9026 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9027 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9028 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9030 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9031 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9032 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9033 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9034 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9036 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9037 @opindex --reference
9038 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
9039 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9040 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
9047 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9048 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9049 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9050 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9051 its referent is being changed.
9056 @opindex --recursive
9057 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
9058 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
9061 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9064 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9067 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9076 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
9079 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
9082 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
9087 @node chgrp invocation
9088 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
9091 @cindex group ownership, changing
9092 @cindex changing group ownership
9094 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
9095 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
9096 or to the group of an existing reference file. Synopsis:
9099 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9102 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
9103 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9104 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9106 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9114 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
9115 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
9124 @cindex error messages, omitting
9125 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
9129 @opindex --dereference
9130 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9132 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9133 This is the default.
9136 @itemx --no-dereference
9138 @opindex --no-dereference
9139 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
9141 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9142 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9143 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9144 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
9146 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9147 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9149 @itemx --preserve-root
9150 @opindex --preserve-root
9151 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9152 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9153 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9154 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9156 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9157 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9158 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9159 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9160 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9162 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9163 @opindex --reference
9164 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
9165 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9166 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9172 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9173 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9174 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9175 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9176 its referent is being changed.
9181 @opindex --recursive
9182 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
9183 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
9186 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9189 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9192 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9201 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
9204 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
9209 @node chmod invocation
9210 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
9213 @cindex changing access permissions
9214 @cindex access permissions, changing
9215 @cindex permissions, changing access
9217 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
9220 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9223 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
9224 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
9225 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
9226 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
9227 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
9228 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
9229 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
9230 recursive directory traversals.
9232 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
9233 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
9234 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
9235 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
9236 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
9237 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
9238 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
9239 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9241 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
9242 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
9243 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
9244 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
9245 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
9246 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
9247 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
9249 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9257 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
9266 @cindex error messages, omitting
9267 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
9270 @itemx --preserve-root
9271 @opindex --preserve-root
9272 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9273 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9274 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9275 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9277 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9278 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9279 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9280 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9281 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9287 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
9289 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9290 @opindex --reference
9291 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
9292 @xref{File permissions}.
9293 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
9294 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9299 @opindex --recursive
9300 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
9301 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
9308 @node touch invocation
9309 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
9312 @cindex changing file timestamps
9313 @cindex file timestamps, changing
9314 @cindex timestamps, changing file
9316 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
9317 specified files. Synopsis:
9320 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
9323 @cindex empty files, creating
9324 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty.
9326 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
9327 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
9330 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
9331 If changing both the access and modification times to the current
9332 time, @command{touch} can change the timestamps for files that the user
9333 running it does not own but has write permission for. Otherwise, the
9334 user must own the files.
9336 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
9337 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
9338 a third one as well: the inode change time. This is often referred to
9339 as a file's @code{ctime}.
9340 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
9341 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
9342 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
9343 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
9344 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
9345 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
9346 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
9347 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
9348 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
9349 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
9350 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
9353 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
9354 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
9355 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
9356 libc, The GNU C Library}. You can avoid ambiguities during
9357 daylight saving transitions by using @sc{utc} time stamps.
9359 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9365 @itemx --time=access
9369 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
9370 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
9371 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
9372 Change the access time only.
9377 @opindex --no-create
9378 Do not create files that do not exist.
9381 @itemx --date=@var{time}
9385 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
9386 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
9387 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
9388 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
9389 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
9390 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. @xref{Date input formats}.
9391 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
9392 silently ignore any excess precision here.
9396 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
9397 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
9401 @itemx --time=modify
9404 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
9405 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
9406 Change the modification time only.
9409 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
9411 @opindex --reference
9412 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
9413 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
9414 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
9415 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
9416 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
9417 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
9419 @item -t [[@var{CC}]@var{YY}]@var{MMDDhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
9420 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
9421 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
9422 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{CC}
9423 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
9424 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
9425 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
9429 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
9430 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
9431 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
9432 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
9433 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{MMDDhhmm}[@var{YY}]} and this
9434 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{YY}, if
9435 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
9436 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
9437 for the other files instead of as a file name.
9438 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
9439 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
9440 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
9441 behavior depends on this variable.
9442 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
9443 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
9453 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
9454 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
9455 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
9458 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
9459 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
9460 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
9461 * sync invocation:: Synchronize memory and disk.
9466 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
9469 @cindex file system disk usage
9470 @cindex disk usage by file system
9472 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
9473 file systems. Synopsis:
9476 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9479 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
9480 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
9481 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
9483 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9484 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9485 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9487 @cindex disk device file
9488 @cindex device file, disk
9489 If an argument @var{file} is a disk device file containing a mounted
9490 file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that file system
9491 rather than on the file system containing the device node (i.e., the root
9492 file system). @sc{gnu} @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
9493 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
9494 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system
9497 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9505 @cindex automounter file systems
9506 @cindex ignore file systems
9507 Include in the listing dummy file systems, which
9508 are omitted by default. Such file systems are typically special-purpose
9509 pseudo-file-systems, such as automounter entries.
9512 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9514 @opindex --block-size
9515 @cindex file system sizes
9516 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9517 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9523 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
9530 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
9531 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
9532 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
9536 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
9537 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9538 (@pxref{Block size}).
9539 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9545 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9546 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
9551 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
9552 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
9553 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
9554 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
9555 out of date. This is the default.
9558 @itemx --portability
9560 @opindex --portability
9561 @cindex one-line output format
9562 @cindex @acronym{POSIX} output format
9563 @cindex portable output format
9564 @cindex output format, portable
9565 Use the @acronym{POSIX} output format. This is like the default format except
9570 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
9571 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
9572 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
9573 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
9576 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to @acronym{POSIX}.
9579 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
9580 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
9581 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
9582 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
9583 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
9590 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
9591 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
9592 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
9593 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
9594 there are many or very busy file systems.
9596 @item -t @var{fstype}
9597 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
9600 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9601 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
9602 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
9603 By default, nothing is omitted.
9608 @opindex --print-type
9609 @cindex file system types, printing
9610 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
9611 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
9612 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
9613 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
9618 @cindex @acronym{NFS} file system type
9619 An @acronym{NFS} file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
9620 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
9623 @item 4.2@r{, }ufs@r{, }efs@dots{}
9624 @cindex Linux file system types
9625 @cindex local file system types
9626 @opindex 4.2 @r{file system type}
9627 @opindex ufs @r{file system type}
9628 @opindex efs @r{file system type}
9629 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
9630 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
9632 @item hsfs@r{, }cdfs
9633 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
9634 @cindex High Sierra file system
9635 @opindex hsfs @r{file system type}
9636 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
9637 A file system on a CD-ROM drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
9638 systems use @samp{hsfs} (@samp{hs} for ``High Sierra'').
9641 @cindex PC file system
9642 @cindex DOS file system
9643 @cindex MS-DOS file system
9644 @cindex diskette file system
9646 An MS-DOS file system, usually on a diskette.
9650 @item -x @var{fstype}
9651 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
9653 @opindex --exclude-type
9654 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
9655 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
9656 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
9659 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
9664 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
9665 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
9666 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
9667 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
9671 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
9674 @cindex file space usage
9675 @cindex disk usage for files
9677 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the specified files
9678 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
9681 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9684 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
9685 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9686 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9687 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9689 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
9690 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
9691 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
9692 that @command{du} outputs.
9694 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9702 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
9704 @itemx --apparent-size
9705 @opindex --apparent-size
9706 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
9707 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
9708 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
9709 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
9710 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
9711 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
9712 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
9713 However, a sparse file created with this command:
9716 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
9720 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
9721 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
9727 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
9730 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9732 @opindex --block-size
9734 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9735 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9741 @cindex grand total of disk space
9742 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
9743 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
9744 a given set of files or directories.
9747 @itemx --dereference-args
9749 @opindex --dereference-args
9750 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
9751 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
9752 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
9753 are often symbolic links.
9755 @itemx --files0-from=@var{FILE}
9756 @opindex --files0-from=@var{FILE}
9757 @cindex including files from @command{du}
9758 Rather than processing files named on the command line, process those
9759 named in file @var{FILE}; each name is terminated by a null byte.
9760 This is useful with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option when
9761 the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
9763 In such cases, running @command{du} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
9764 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{du} print a
9765 total for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
9766 One way to produce a list of null-byte-terminated file names is with @sc{gnu}
9767 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
9768 Do not specify any @var{FILE} on the command line when using this option.
9774 Currently, @option{-H} is the same as @option{--si},
9775 except that @option{-H} evokes a warning.
9776 This option will be changed to be equivalent to
9777 @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
9781 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
9782 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9783 (@pxref{Block size}).
9784 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9787 @itemx --count-links
9789 @opindex --count-links
9790 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
9791 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
9795 @itemx --dereference
9797 @opindex --dereference
9798 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9799 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
9800 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
9805 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
9806 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9807 (@pxref{Block size}).
9808 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
9811 @itemx --no-dereference
9813 @opindex --no-dereference
9814 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9815 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
9816 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
9818 @item --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9819 @opindex --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9820 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
9821 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
9822 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
9823 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
9829 @cindex output null-byte-terminated lines
9830 Output a null byte at the end of each line, rather than a newline.
9831 This option enables other programs to parse the output of @command{du}
9832 even when that output would contain file names with embedded newlines.
9839 @opindex --summarize
9840 Display only a total for each argument.
9843 @itemx --separate-dirs
9845 @opindex --separate-dirs
9846 Report the size of each directory separately, not including the sizes
9851 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
9852 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
9853 or any of its subdirectories.
9856 @itemx --time=status
9859 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
9860 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
9861 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
9862 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
9863 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
9866 @itemx --time=access
9868 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
9869 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
9870 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
9871 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
9873 @item --time-style=@var{style}
9874 @opindex --time-style
9876 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
9877 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
9878 be one of the following:
9883 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
9884 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
9885 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
9886 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
9887 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
9888 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
9891 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
9892 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
9893 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
9894 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
9897 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
9898 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
9899 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
9900 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
9903 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
9904 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
9908 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
9909 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
9910 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
9911 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
9912 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
9913 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
9914 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
9917 @itemx --one-file-system
9919 @opindex --one-file-system
9920 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
9921 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
9922 the argument being processed is on.
9924 @item --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
9925 @opindex --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
9926 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
9927 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{PATTERN}.
9928 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
9932 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
9933 @opindex -X @var{FILE}
9934 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
9935 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
9936 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{FILE},
9937 one per line. If @var{FILE} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
9942 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
9943 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
9944 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
9945 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
9946 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
9947 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
9952 @node stat invocation
9953 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
9957 @cindex file system status
9959 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
9962 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9965 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
9966 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
9967 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
9968 also give information about the files the links point to.
9974 @itemx --dereference
9976 @opindex --dereference
9977 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
9978 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
9979 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
9980 by each symbolic link argument.
9981 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
9984 @itemx --file-system
9986 @opindex --file-system
9987 @cindex file systems
9988 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
9989 instead of information about the files themselves.
9992 @itemx --format=@var{format}
9994 @opindex --format=@var{format}
9995 @cindex output format
9996 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
9997 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
9998 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
9999 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
10001 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
10006 @itemx --printf=@var{format}
10007 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
10008 @cindex output format
10009 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
10010 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
10011 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
10012 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
10013 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
10014 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
10016 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
10025 @cindex terse output
10026 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
10028 The valid format sequences for files are:
10031 @item %a - Access rights in octal
10032 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
10033 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
10034 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
10035 @item %d - Device number in decimal
10036 @item %D - Device number in hex
10037 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
10038 @item %F - File type
10039 @item %g - Group ID of owner
10040 @item %G - Group name of owner
10041 @item %h - Number of hard links
10042 @item %i - Inode number
10043 @item %n - File name
10044 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
10045 @item %o - I/O block size
10046 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
10047 @item %t - Major device type in hex
10048 @item %T - Minor device type in hex
10049 @item %u - User ID of owner
10050 @item %U - User name of owner
10051 @item %x - Time of last access
10052 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
10053 @item %y - Time of last modification
10054 @item %Y - Time of last modification as seconds since Epoch
10055 @item %z - Time of last change
10056 @item %Z - Time of last change as seconds since Epoch
10059 The valid format sequences for file systems are:
10062 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
10063 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
10064 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
10065 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
10066 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
10067 @item %i - File System ID in hex
10068 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
10069 @item %n - File name
10070 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
10071 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
10072 @item %t - Type in hex
10073 @item %T - Type in human readable form
10077 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
10078 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
10079 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
10080 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
10086 @node sync invocation
10087 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize data on disk with memory
10090 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
10092 @cindex superblock, writing
10093 @cindex inodes, written buffered
10094 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
10095 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
10096 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
10097 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync} system
10100 @cindex crashes and corruption
10101 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
10102 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
10103 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
10104 result. The @command{sync} command ensures everything in memory
10105 is written to disk.
10107 Any arguments are ignored, except for a lone @option{--help} or
10108 @option{--version} (@pxref{Common options}).
10113 @node Printing text
10114 @chapter Printing text
10116 @cindex printing text, commands for
10117 @cindex commands for printing text
10119 This section describes commands that display text strings.
10122 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
10123 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
10124 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
10128 @node echo invocation
10129 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
10132 @cindex displaying text
10133 @cindex printing text
10134 @cindex text, displaying
10135 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
10137 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
10138 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
10141 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
10144 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10145 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
10146 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
10152 Do not output the trailing newline.
10156 @cindex backslash escapes
10157 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
10166 suppress trailing newline
10180 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10181 (zero to three octal digits)
10183 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10184 (one to three octal digits)
10186 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
10187 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
10192 @cindex backslash escapes
10193 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
10194 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
10195 specified, the last one given takes effect.
10199 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10200 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
10201 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
10202 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
10203 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
10204 plain @samp{hello}.
10206 @acronym{POSIX} does not require support for any options, and says
10207 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
10208 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
10209 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
10210 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
10211 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
10216 @node printf invocation
10217 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
10220 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
10223 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
10226 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
10227 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
10228 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function. The
10229 differences are as follows:
10234 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
10235 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
10239 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
10240 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
10241 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
10245 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
10246 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
10247 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
10250 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
10251 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
10252 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
10253 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
10258 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
10259 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
10260 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
10261 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits.
10262 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
10263 from the converted string.
10266 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
10267 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
10271 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10272 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
10273 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
10274 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
10275 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
10276 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
10277 @samp{97} on hosts that use the @acronym{ASCII} character set, since
10278 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in @acronym{ASCII}.
10283 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
10284 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
10285 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
10286 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
10287 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
10291 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
10292 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a character to print,
10293 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
10294 digits) specifying a character to print.
10299 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
10301 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
10302 @acronym{ISO} C 99:
10303 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (@acronym{ISO}/@acronym{IEC} 10646)
10304 characters, specified as
10305 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
10306 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
10307 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
10308 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale.
10310 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
10311 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
10312 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
10313 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
10315 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
10316 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
10317 Options must precede operands.
10319 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
10320 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
10323 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u20AC 14.95'
10327 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
10328 (@acronym{ISO}-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
10331 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
10335 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
10337 Note that in these examples, the full name of @command{printf} has been
10338 given, to distinguish it from the GNU @code{bash} built-in function
10341 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
10342 values of each character one by one. @acronym{ASCII} characters mixed with \u
10343 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
10344 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
10345 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
10346 this text in a locale-independent way:
10349 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
10350 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
10351 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
10352 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
10359 @node yes invocation
10360 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
10363 @cindex repeated output of a string
10365 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
10366 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
10367 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
10369 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
10371 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10372 To output an argument that begins with
10373 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
10374 @xref{Common options}.
10378 @chapter Conditions
10381 @cindex commands for exit status
10382 @cindex exit status commands
10384 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
10385 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
10386 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
10390 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
10391 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
10392 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
10393 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
10397 @node false invocation
10398 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
10401 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
10402 @cindex failure exit status
10403 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
10405 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
10406 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10407 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
10408 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
10409 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10410 command, not the one documented here.
10412 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10414 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10415 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10416 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10418 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
10419 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
10420 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10422 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
10423 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
10424 non-@acronym{GNU} hosts.
10427 @node true invocation
10428 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
10431 @cindex do nothing, successfully
10433 @cindex successful exit
10434 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
10436 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
10437 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10438 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
10439 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
10440 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
10441 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10442 command, not the one documented here.
10444 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10446 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
10447 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
10448 option, and with standard
10449 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
10450 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
10453 $ ./true --version >&-
10454 ./true: write error: Bad file number
10455 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
10456 ./true: write error: No space left on device
10459 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10460 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10461 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10463 @node test invocation
10464 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
10467 @cindex check file types
10468 @cindex compare values
10469 @cindex expression evaluation
10471 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
10472 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
10473 expression must be a separate argument.
10475 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
10476 comparison operators.
10478 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
10479 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
10480 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
10481 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
10482 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
10483 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
10489 test @var{expression}
10491 [ @var{expression} ]
10496 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
10497 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
10498 Because most shells have a built-in @command{test} command, using an
10499 unadorned @command{test} in a script or interactively may get you
10500 different functionality than that described here.
10502 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
10503 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
10504 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true otherwise. The argument
10505 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
10506 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
10507 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
10508 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
10509 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
10511 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
10515 0 if the expression is true,
10516 1 if the expression is false,
10517 2 if an error occurred.
10521 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
10522 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
10523 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
10524 * String tests:: -z -n = !=
10525 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
10526 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
10530 @node File type tests
10531 @subsection File type tests
10533 @cindex file type tests
10535 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
10536 but not all files are the same!)
10540 @item -b @var{file}
10542 @cindex block special check
10543 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
10545 @item -c @var{file}
10547 @cindex character special check
10548 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
10550 @item -d @var{file}
10552 @cindex directory check
10553 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
10555 @item -f @var{file}
10557 @cindex regular file check
10558 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
10560 @item -h @var{file}
10561 @itemx -L @var{file}
10564 @cindex symbolic link check
10565 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
10566 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
10567 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
10569 @item -p @var{file}
10571 @cindex named pipe check
10572 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
10574 @item -S @var{file}
10576 @cindex socket check
10577 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
10581 @cindex terminal check
10582 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
10588 @node Access permission tests
10589 @subsection Access permission tests
10591 @cindex access permission tests
10592 @cindex permission tests
10594 These options test for particular access permissions.
10598 @item -g @var{file}
10600 @cindex set-group-ID check
10601 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
10603 @item -k @var{file}
10605 @cindex sticky bit check
10606 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
10608 @item -r @var{file}
10610 @cindex readable file check
10611 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
10613 @item -u @var{file}
10615 @cindex set-user-ID check
10616 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
10618 @item -w @var{file}
10620 @cindex writable file check
10621 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
10623 @item -x @var{file}
10625 @cindex executable file check
10626 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
10627 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
10629 @item -O @var{file}
10631 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
10632 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
10634 @item -G @var{file}
10636 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
10637 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
10641 @node File characteristic tests
10642 @subsection File characteristic tests
10644 @cindex file characteristic tests
10646 These options test other file characteristics.
10650 @item -e @var{file}
10652 @cindex existence-of-file check
10653 True if @var{file} exists.
10655 @item -s @var{file}
10657 @cindex nonempty file check
10658 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
10660 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
10662 @cindex newer-than file check
10663 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
10664 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
10666 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
10668 @cindex older-than file check
10669 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
10670 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
10672 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
10674 @cindex same file check
10675 @cindex hard link check
10676 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
10677 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
10683 @subsection String tests
10685 @cindex string tests
10687 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
10688 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
10694 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
10695 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
10699 @item -z @var{string}
10701 @cindex zero-length string check
10702 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
10704 @item -n @var{string}
10705 @itemx @var{string}
10707 @cindex nonzero-length string check
10708 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
10710 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
10712 @cindex equal string check
10713 True if the strings are equal.
10715 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
10717 @cindex not-equal string check
10718 True if the strings are not equal.
10723 @node Numeric tests
10724 @subsection Numeric tests
10726 @cindex numeric tests
10727 @cindex arithmetic tests
10729 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
10730 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
10731 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
10735 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
10736 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
10737 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
10738 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
10739 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
10740 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
10747 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
10748 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
10749 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
10756 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
10758 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
10761 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
10765 @node Connectives for test
10766 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
10768 @cindex logical connectives
10769 @cindex connectives, logical
10771 The usual logical connectives.
10777 True if @var{expr} is false.
10779 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
10781 @cindex logical and operator
10782 @cindex and operator
10783 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
10785 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
10787 @cindex logical or operator
10788 @cindex or operator
10789 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
10794 @node expr invocation
10795 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
10798 @cindex expression evaluation
10799 @cindex evaluation of expressions
10801 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
10802 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
10804 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
10805 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
10806 @command{expr} converts
10807 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
10808 depending on the operation being applied to it.
10810 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
10811 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
10812 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
10813 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
10814 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
10815 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
10816 work around this is to use the @sc{gnu} extension @code{+},
10817 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
10818 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
10819 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
10821 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
10822 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
10823 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
10824 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
10825 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
10826 leading spaces as mentioned above.
10828 @cindex parentheses for grouping
10829 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
10830 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
10831 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
10834 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
10835 options}. Options must precede operands.
10837 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
10841 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
10842 1 if the expression is null or 0,
10843 2 if the expression is invalid,
10844 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
10848 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
10849 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
10850 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
10851 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
10855 @node String expressions
10856 @subsection String expressions
10858 @cindex string expressions
10859 @cindex expressions, string
10861 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
10862 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
10863 the next sections).
10867 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
10868 @cindex pattern matching
10869 @cindex regular expression matching
10870 @cindex matching patterns
10871 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
10872 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
10873 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
10874 then matched against this regular expression.
10876 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
10877 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
10878 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
10880 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
10881 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
10883 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
10884 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
10885 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
10886 expression operators.
10888 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
10889 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
10890 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
10891 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
10892 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
10893 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
10894 characters. (@acronym{POSIX} allows either behavior.)
10895 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
10896 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
10898 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
10900 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
10901 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
10903 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
10905 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
10906 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
10907 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
10909 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
10911 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
10912 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
10913 @var{string}, return 0.
10915 @item length @var{string}
10917 Returns the length of @var{string}.
10919 @item + @var{token}
10921 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
10922 or an operator like @code{/}.
10923 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
10924 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
10925 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
10926 This operator is a @acronym{GNU} extension. Portable shell scripts should use
10927 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
10931 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
10932 @code{quote} operator.
10935 @node Numeric expressions
10936 @subsection Numeric expressions
10938 @cindex numeric expressions
10939 @cindex expressions, numeric
10941 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
10942 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
10943 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
10944 than the connectives (next section).
10952 @cindex subtraction
10953 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
10954 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
10960 @cindex multiplication
10963 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
10964 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
10969 @node Relations for expr
10970 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
10972 @cindex connectives, logical
10973 @cindex logical connectives
10974 @cindex relations, numeric or string
10976 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
10977 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
10978 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
10984 @cindex logical or operator
10985 @cindex or operator
10986 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
10987 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
10988 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
10993 @cindex logical and operator
10994 @cindex and operator
10995 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
10996 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
10999 @item < <= = == != >= >
11006 @cindex comparison operators
11008 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
11009 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
11010 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
11011 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
11012 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
11017 @node Examples of expr
11018 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
11020 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
11021 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
11023 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
11026 foo=`expr $foo + 1`
11029 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
11030 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
11033 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
11036 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
11044 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
11046 expr index abcdef cz
11049 @error{} expr: syntax error
11050 expr index quote index a
11056 @chapter Redirection
11058 @cindex redirection
11059 @cindex commands for redirection
11061 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
11062 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
11063 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
11064 it's described here.
11067 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
11071 @node tee invocation
11072 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
11075 @cindex pipe fitting
11076 @cindex destinations, multiple output
11077 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
11079 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
11080 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
11081 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
11084 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11087 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
11088 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
11089 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
11091 A @var{file} of @samp{-} causes @command{tee} to send another copy of
11092 input to standard output, but this is typically not that useful as the
11093 copies are interleaved.
11095 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11102 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
11106 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
11108 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
11109 Ignore interrupt signals.
11113 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
11114 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
11115 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
11116 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
11117 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
11120 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
11123 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
11124 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
11125 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
11126 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
11128 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
11129 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
11130 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
11133 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
11134 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11135 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
11138 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
11139 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
11140 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
11142 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
11143 called @dfn{process substitution}
11144 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
11145 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bashref,
11146 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
11147 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
11148 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
11149 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
11151 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
11152 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
11155 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11156 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
11159 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
11160 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
11161 process substitution is required:
11164 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11165 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
11166 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
11170 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
11171 copy of the contents of a pipe.
11172 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
11173 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
11174 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
11175 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
11176 the uncompressed output.
11178 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
11179 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
11182 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
11183 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
11186 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
11187 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
11190 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
11193 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
11194 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
11195 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
11196 there may be a better way.
11197 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
11198 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
11199 (slightly simplified):
11202 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11203 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
11204 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11207 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
11208 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
11209 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
11210 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
11213 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11214 tar chof - "$tardir" \
11215 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
11216 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11222 @node File name manipulation
11223 @chapter File name manipulation
11225 @cindex file name manipulation
11226 @cindex manipulation of file names
11227 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
11229 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
11232 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
11233 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name.
11234 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability.
11238 @node basename invocation
11239 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
11242 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
11243 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
11244 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
11245 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
11246 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
11248 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
11249 @var{name}. Synopsis:
11252 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
11255 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
11256 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
11257 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
11258 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
11261 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
11262 @macro basenameAndDirname
11263 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
11264 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
11265 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
11266 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
11268 @basenameAndDirname
11270 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11271 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, @acronym{GNU}
11272 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
11273 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11274 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11276 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11277 options}. Options must precede operands.
11285 basename /usr/bin/sort
11288 basename include/stdio.h .h
11292 @node dirname invocation
11293 @section @command{dirname}: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
11296 @cindex directory components, printing
11297 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
11298 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
11300 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component of
11301 a string (presumably a file name). Synopsis:
11307 If @var{name} is a single component, @command{dirname} prints @samp{.}
11308 (meaning the current directory).
11310 @basenameAndDirname
11312 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11313 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With @acronym{GNU} @command{dirname}, the
11314 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11315 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11317 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11325 # Output "/usr/bin".
11326 dirname /usr/bin/sort
11333 @node pathchk invocation
11334 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name portability
11337 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
11338 @cindex valid file names, checking for
11339 @cindex portable file names, checking for
11341 @command{pathchk} checks portability of file names. Synopsis:
11344 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11347 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints a message if any of
11348 these conditions is true:
11352 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
11353 (execute) permission,
11355 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
11358 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
11359 its file system's maximum.
11362 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
11363 name could be created under the above conditions.
11365 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11366 Options must precede operands.
11372 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
11373 print a message if any of these conditions is true:
11377 A file name is empty.
11380 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
11381 @acronym{POSIX} minimum limits for portability.
11384 A file name contains a character outside the portable file name
11385 character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{-},
11386 @samp{.}, @samp{/}, and @samp{_}.
11391 Print a message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
11392 that begins with @samp{-}.
11394 @item --portability
11395 @opindex --portability
11396 Print a message if a file name is not portable to all @acronym{POSIX}
11397 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
11401 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
11405 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
11410 @node Working context
11411 @chapter Working context
11413 @cindex working context
11414 @cindex commands for printing the working context
11416 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
11417 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
11418 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
11421 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
11422 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
11423 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
11424 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
11428 @node pwd invocation
11429 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
11432 @cindex print name of current directory
11433 @cindex current working directory, printing
11434 @cindex working directory, printing
11436 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
11437 @command{pwd} prints the fully resolved name of the current directory.
11438 That is, all components of the printed name will be actual directory
11439 names---none will be symbolic links.
11441 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
11442 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
11443 Because most shells have a built-in @command{pwd} command, using an
11444 unadorned @command{pwd} in a script or interactively may get you
11445 different functionality than that described here.
11447 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
11448 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
11453 @node stty invocation
11454 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
11457 @cindex change or print terminal settings
11458 @cindex terminal settings
11459 @cindex line settings of terminal
11461 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
11465 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
11466 stty [@var{option}]
11469 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
11470 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
11471 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
11472 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
11473 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
11474 @option{--file} option.
11476 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
11477 the terminal line operation, as described below.
11479 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11486 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
11487 be used in combination with any line settings.
11489 @item -F @var{device}
11490 @itemx --file=@var{device}
11493 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
11494 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
11495 because opening a @acronym{POSIX} tty requires use of the @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to
11496 prevent a @acronym{POSIX} tty from blocking until the carrier detect line is high if
11497 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
11498 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
11504 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
11505 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
11506 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
11507 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
11511 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
11512 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
11513 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
11514 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
11517 Some settings are not available on all @acronym{POSIX} systems, since they use
11518 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with ``Non-@acronym{POSIX}'' in their
11519 description. On non-@acronym{POSIX} systems, those or other settings also may not
11520 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
11526 * Control:: Control settings
11527 * Input:: Input settings
11528 * Output:: Output settings
11529 * Local:: Local settings
11530 * Combination:: Combination settings
11531 * Characters:: Special characters
11532 * Special:: Special settings
11537 @subsection Control settings
11539 @cindex control settings
11545 @cindex two-way parity
11546 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
11552 @cindex even parity
11553 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
11560 @cindex character size
11561 @cindex eight-bit characters
11562 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
11567 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
11573 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
11577 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
11581 @cindex modem control
11582 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
11586 @cindex hardware flow control
11587 @cindex flow control, hardware
11588 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
11589 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11594 @subsection Input settings
11596 @cindex input settings
11601 @cindex breaks, ignoring
11602 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
11606 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
11607 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
11611 @cindex parity, ignoring
11612 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
11616 @cindex parity errors, marking
11617 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
11621 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
11625 @cindex eight-bit input
11626 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
11630 @cindex newline, translating to return
11631 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
11635 @cindex return, ignoring
11636 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
11640 @cindex return, translating to newline
11641 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
11645 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
11646 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
11650 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
11651 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
11652 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{CTRL-S}/@kbd{CTRL-Q}). May
11659 @cindex software flow control
11660 @cindex flow control, software
11661 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
11662 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
11663 empty again. May be negated.
11667 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
11668 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11673 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
11674 if negated). Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11678 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
11679 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
11680 when the input buffer is full. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11685 @subsection Output settings
11687 @cindex output settings
11688 These arguments specify output-related operations.
11693 Postprocess output. May be negated.
11697 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
11698 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11703 @cindex return, translating to newline
11704 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11708 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
11709 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11714 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11719 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11723 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
11724 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11729 @cindex pad character
11730 Use delete characters for fill instead of null characters. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11736 Newline delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11743 Carriage return delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11749 @opindex tab@var{n}
11750 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11755 Backspace delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11760 Vertical tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11765 Form feed delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11770 @subsection Local settings
11772 @cindex local settings
11777 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
11778 characters. May be negated.
11782 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
11783 special characters. May be negated.
11787 Enable non-@acronym{POSIX} special characters. May be negated.
11791 Echo input characters. May be negated.
11797 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
11802 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
11803 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
11807 @cindex newline, echoing
11808 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
11812 @cindex flushing, disabling
11813 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
11814 characters. May be negated.
11818 @cindex case translation
11819 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
11820 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
11821 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11825 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
11826 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11833 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
11834 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11840 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
11841 @cindex hat notation for control characters
11842 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
11843 of literally. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11849 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
11850 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
11851 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11857 @subsection Combination settings
11859 @cindex combination settings
11860 Combination settings:
11867 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
11868 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
11872 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
11873 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
11877 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
11878 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
11882 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
11889 @c This is too long to write inline.
11891 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl -ixoff
11892 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel opost -olcuc -ocrnl onlcr
11893 -onocr -onlret -ofill -ofdel nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0
11894 ff0 isig icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl
11895 -noflsh -xcase -tostop -echoprt echoctl echoke
11899 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
11903 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
11904 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
11905 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
11906 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
11913 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
11914 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -iuclc -ixany
11915 -imaxbel -opost -isig -icanon -xcase min 1 time 0
11919 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
11923 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
11928 @cindex eight-bit characters
11929 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
11930 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
11934 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
11935 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
11939 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11943 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated. If negated, same
11950 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11954 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
11958 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
11963 @subsection Special characters
11965 @cindex special characters
11966 @cindex characters, special
11968 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
11969 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
11970 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
11971 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
11972 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
11973 any other digit to indicate decimal.
11975 @cindex disabling special characters
11976 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
11977 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
11978 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
11979 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
11980 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
11981 special character to @key{U}.)
11987 Send an interrupt signal.
11991 Send a quit signal.
11995 Erase the last character typed.
11999 Erase the current line.
12003 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
12011 Alternate character to end the line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12015 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12019 Restart the output after stopping it.
12027 Send a terminal stop signal.
12031 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12035 Redraw the current line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12039 Erase the last word typed. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12043 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
12044 character. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12049 @subsection Special settings
12051 @cindex special settings
12056 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
12057 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12061 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
12062 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12064 @item ispeed @var{n}
12066 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
12068 @item ospeed @var{n}
12070 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
12074 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12077 @itemx columns @var{n}
12080 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12086 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
12087 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
12088 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
12089 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
12090 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12094 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12098 Print the terminal speed.
12101 @cindex baud rate, setting
12102 @c FIXME: Is this still true that the baud rate can't be set
12103 @c higher than 38400?
12104 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one
12105 of: 0 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600
12106 19200 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as
12107 19200; @code{extb} is the same as 38400. 0 hangs up the line if
12108 @option{-clocal} is set.
12112 @node printenv invocation
12113 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
12116 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
12117 @cindex environment variables, printing
12119 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
12122 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
12125 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
12126 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
12127 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
12129 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12130 @xref{Common options}.
12132 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
12136 0 if all variables specified were found
12137 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
12138 2 if a write error occurred
12142 @node tty invocation
12143 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
12146 @cindex print terminal file name
12147 @cindex terminal file name, printing
12149 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
12150 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
12154 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
12157 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12167 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
12171 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
12175 0 if standard input is a terminal
12176 1 if standard input is not a terminal
12177 2 if given incorrect arguments
12178 3 if a write error occurs
12182 @node User information
12183 @chapter User information
12185 @cindex user information, commands for
12186 @cindex commands for printing user information
12188 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
12189 logins, groups, and so forth.
12192 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
12193 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
12194 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
12195 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
12196 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
12197 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
12201 @node id invocation
12202 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
12205 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
12206 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
12207 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
12209 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
12210 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
12213 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{username}]
12216 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
12217 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
12218 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
12220 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
12221 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
12223 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
12224 Also see @ref{Common options}.
12231 Print only the group ID.
12237 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
12243 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
12244 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12250 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID. Requires
12251 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12257 Print only the user ID.
12263 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
12264 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
12265 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
12266 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
12267 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
12268 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
12269 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
12271 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
12273 @node logname invocation
12274 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
12277 @cindex printing user's login name
12278 @cindex login name, printing
12279 @cindex user name, printing
12282 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
12283 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12284 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
12285 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
12286 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
12288 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12294 @node whoami invocation
12295 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
12298 @cindex effective user ID, printing
12299 @cindex printing the effective user ID
12301 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
12302 effective user ID. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
12304 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12310 @node groups invocation
12311 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
12314 @cindex printing groups a user is in
12315 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
12317 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
12318 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
12319 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
12321 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
12322 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
12325 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
12328 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
12330 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
12332 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12338 @node users invocation
12339 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
12342 @cindex printing current usernames
12343 @cindex usernames, printing current
12345 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
12346 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
12347 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
12348 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
12349 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
12358 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
12359 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12360 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
12361 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
12363 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12369 @node who invocation
12370 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
12373 @cindex printing current user information
12374 @cindex information, about current users
12376 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
12380 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
12383 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
12385 @cindex remote hostname
12386 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
12387 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
12388 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
12392 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
12393 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12394 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
12395 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
12396 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
12400 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
12401 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
12402 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
12403 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
12406 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
12407 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
12408 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
12409 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
12411 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12419 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
12425 Print the date and time of last system boot.
12431 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
12437 Print column headings.
12441 Same as @samp{who am i}.
12447 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
12448 Overrides all other options.
12452 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
12457 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
12458 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
12459 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
12465 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
12466 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
12470 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
12471 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
12472 automatic dial-up internet access.
12478 Print a line of column headings.
12489 @opindex --writable
12490 @cindex message status
12491 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
12492 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
12495 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
12496 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
12497 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
12505 @node System context
12506 @chapter System context
12508 @cindex system context
12509 @cindex context, system
12510 @cindex commands for system context
12512 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
12516 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
12517 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
12518 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
12519 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
12520 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
12524 @node date invocation
12525 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
12528 @cindex time, printing or setting
12529 @cindex printing the current time
12534 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
12535 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
12536 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
12540 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
12541 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12542 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
12543 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
12546 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
12547 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
12548 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
12549 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
12551 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
12552 @cindex time formats
12553 @cindex formatting times
12554 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
12555 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
12556 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
12557 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
12558 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
12559 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
12565 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
12566 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
12567 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
12568 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
12569 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
12570 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
12572 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
12574 * Examples of date:: Examples.
12577 @node Time conversion specifiers
12578 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
12580 @cindex time conversion specifiers
12581 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
12583 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
12587 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
12589 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12591 hour (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}).
12592 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12594 hour (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}).
12595 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12597 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
12599 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
12600 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12602 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
12603 blank in many locales.
12604 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
12606 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
12607 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12609 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
12611 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
12612 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12614 @cindex epoch, seconds since
12615 @cindex seconds since the epoch
12616 @cindex beginning of time
12617 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC.
12618 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
12619 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
12620 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12622 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
12623 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
12625 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
12627 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
12629 @w{@acronym{RFC} 2822/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone
12630 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
12631 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
12632 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
12633 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
12634 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
12635 by the @option{--date} option.
12636 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12638 @w{@acronym{RFC} 3339/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone with
12639 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
12640 zone is determinable.
12641 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12643 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
12644 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
12646 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12648 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
12649 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
12650 no time zone is determinable.
12651 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12653 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
12654 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
12658 @node Date conversion specifiers
12659 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
12661 @cindex date conversion specifiers
12662 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
12664 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
12668 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
12670 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
12672 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
12674 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
12676 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
12678 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
12679 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
12680 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
12681 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
12683 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
12685 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
12687 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
12689 full date in @acronym{ISO} 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12690 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
12691 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
12693 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12695 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number, but without the century
12696 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
12697 as @samp{%y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO} week number (see
12699 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
12700 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12702 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number. This has the
12703 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO}
12705 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
12707 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
12708 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
12709 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
12710 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12714 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
12716 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12718 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
12720 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
12721 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12722 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
12724 @acronym{ISO} week number, that is, the
12725 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
12726 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12727 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
12728 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
12729 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the @acronym{ISO} 8601
12732 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
12734 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
12735 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12736 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
12738 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
12740 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
12742 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
12743 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
12744 precedes year @samp{0000}.
12748 @node Literal conversion specifiers
12749 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
12751 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
12752 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
12754 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
12766 @node Padding and other flags
12767 @subsection Padding and other flags
12769 @cindex numeric field padding
12770 @cindex padding of numeric fields
12771 @cindex fields, padding numeric
12773 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
12774 with zeros, so that, for
12775 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
12776 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
12777 since there is no natural width for them.
12779 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
12780 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
12784 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
12787 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
12788 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
12790 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
12791 would normally pad with spaces.
12793 Use upper case characters if possible.
12795 Use opposite case characters if possible.
12796 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
12800 Here are some examples of padding:
12803 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
12805 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
12807 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
12811 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, you can specify the field width
12812 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
12813 output is of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
12814 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
12815 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
12816 a field of width 9.
12818 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
12819 specification. The modifiers are:
12823 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
12824 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
12825 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
12826 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
12830 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
12831 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
12834 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
12835 is available, it is ignored.
12838 @node Setting the time
12839 @subsection Setting the time
12841 @cindex setting the time
12842 @cindex time setting
12843 @cindex appropriate privileges
12845 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
12846 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
12847 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
12848 system clock. The @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be
12849 used with such an argument. The @option{--universal} option may be used
12850 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
12851 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time
12854 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
12867 first two digits of year (optional)
12869 last two digits of year (optional)
12874 The @option{--set} option also sets the system clock; see the next section.
12877 @node Options for date
12878 @subsection Options for @command{date}
12880 @cindex @command{date} options
12881 @cindex options for @command{date}
12883 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12887 @item -d @var{datestr}
12888 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
12891 @cindex parsing date strings
12892 @cindex date strings, parsing
12893 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
12896 @opindex next @var{day}
12897 @opindex last @var{day}
12898 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
12899 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
12900 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
12901 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
12902 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
12903 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
12904 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}.@*
12905 @xref{Date input formats}.
12907 @item -f @var{datefile}
12908 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
12911 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
12912 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
12913 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
12914 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
12917 @item -r @var{file}
12918 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
12920 @opindex --reference
12921 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
12922 instead of the current date and time.
12929 @opindex --rfc-2822
12930 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
12931 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
12935 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
12938 This format conforms to
12939 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
12940 @acronym{RFCs} 2822} and
12941 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
12942 current and previous standards for Internet email.
12944 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
12945 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
12946 Display the date using a format specified by
12947 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
12948 @acronym{RFC} 3339}. This is a subset of the @acronym{ISO} 8601
12949 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
12950 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
12951 standard formats, @acronym{RFC} 3339 format is always suitable as
12952 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
12953 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
12955 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
12956 It can be one of the following:
12960 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
12961 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12964 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
12965 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
12966 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
12967 hours and thirty minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. This is equivalent to
12968 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
12971 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
12972 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
12973 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
12977 @item -s @var{datestr}
12978 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
12981 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
12988 @opindex --universal
12989 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
12991 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
12994 Use Coordinated Universal Time (@acronym{UTC}) by operating as if the
12995 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
12997 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (@sc{gmt}) for
12998 historical reasons.
13002 @node Examples of date
13003 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
13005 @cindex examples of @command{date}
13007 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
13008 option in the previous section.
13013 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
13016 date --date='2 days ago'
13020 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
13023 date --date='3 months 1 day'
13027 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
13030 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
13034 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
13040 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
13041 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
13042 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
13045 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
13046 of the month, you can use the (@acronym{GNU} extension)
13047 @samp{-} flag to suppress
13048 the padding altogether:
13051 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
13055 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
13056 non-@acronym{GNU} versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
13059 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
13063 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
13066 date --set='+2 minutes'
13070 To print the date in @acronym{RFC} 2822 format,
13071 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
13074 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
13077 @anchor{%s-examples}
13079 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
13080 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
13081 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
13082 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
13083 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
13087 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
13091 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
13092 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
13093 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
13094 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
13095 seconds) behind UTC:
13098 # local time zone used
13099 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
13104 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
13105 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
13106 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
13107 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
13110 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
13114 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
13115 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
13116 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
13117 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
13118 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
13121 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
13125 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
13126 a more readable form, use a command like this:
13129 # local time zone used
13130 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13131 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13134 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
13135 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
13138 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
13139 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13142 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
13145 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13146 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
13152 @node arch invocation
13153 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
13156 @cindex print machine hardware name
13157 @cindex system information, printing
13159 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
13160 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
13164 arch [@var{option}]
13167 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
13172 @node uname invocation
13173 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
13176 @cindex print system information
13177 @cindex system information, printing
13179 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
13180 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
13181 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
13184 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
13187 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
13188 printed in this order:
13191 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
13192 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
13195 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
13196 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
13197 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
13201 @result{} Linux dum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
13205 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13213 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
13214 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
13217 @itemx --hardware-platform
13219 @opindex --hardware-platform
13220 @cindex implementation, hardware
13221 @cindex hardware platform
13222 @cindex platform, hardware
13223 Print the hardware platform name
13224 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
13225 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13226 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13232 @cindex machine type
13233 @cindex hardware class
13234 @cindex hardware type
13235 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
13241 @opindex --nodename
13244 @cindex network node name
13245 Print the network node hostname.
13250 @opindex --processor
13251 @cindex host processor type
13252 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
13253 architecture or ISA).
13254 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13255 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13258 @itemx --operating-system
13260 @opindex --operating-system
13261 @cindex operating system name
13262 Print the name of the operating system.
13265 @itemx --kernel-release
13267 @opindex --kernel-release
13268 @cindex kernel release
13269 @cindex release of kernel
13270 Print the kernel release.
13273 @itemx --kernel-name
13275 @opindex --kernel-name
13276 @cindex kernel name
13277 @cindex name of kernel
13278 Print the kernel name.
13279 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
13280 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
13281 @acronym{POSIX} specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
13282 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
13283 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
13284 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
13285 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
13289 @itemx --kernel-version
13291 @opindex --kernel-version
13292 @cindex kernel version
13293 @cindex version of kernel
13294 Print the kernel version.
13301 @node hostname invocation
13302 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
13305 @cindex setting the hostname
13306 @cindex printing the hostname
13307 @cindex system name, printing
13308 @cindex appropriate privileges
13310 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
13311 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
13312 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
13316 hostname [@var{name}]
13319 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13325 @node hostid invocation
13326 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier.
13329 @cindex printing the host identifier
13331 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
13332 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
13333 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
13334 @xref{Common options}.
13336 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
13343 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
13344 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
13350 @node Modified command invocation
13351 @chapter Modified command invocation
13353 @cindex modified command invocation
13354 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
13355 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
13357 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
13358 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
13362 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
13363 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
13364 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
13365 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
13366 * su invocation:: Modify user and group ID.
13370 @node chroot invocation
13371 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
13374 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
13375 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
13377 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
13378 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
13379 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
13380 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
13381 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
13382 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.}
13386 chroot @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13387 chroot @var{option}
13390 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
13391 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
13392 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist) and then runs
13393 @var{command} with optional @var{args}. If @var{command} is not
13394 specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL} environment
13395 variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the @option{-i} option.
13396 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
13397 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13399 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13400 options}. Options must precede operands.
13402 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
13403 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
13404 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
13405 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
13406 your new root directory.
13408 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
13409 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
13412 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
13415 Then you'll see output like this:
13420 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
13423 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
13424 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
13425 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
13426 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
13427 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
13428 device files), copy them into place, too.
13430 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
13434 1 if @command{chroot} itself fails
13435 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13436 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13437 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13441 @node env invocation
13442 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
13445 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
13446 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
13447 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
13449 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
13452 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
13453 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13457 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
13458 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
13459 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
13460 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
13461 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
13462 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
13464 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
13465 characters other than @samp{=} and the null character (@acronym{ASCII}
13466 @sc{nul}). However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
13467 consist solely of underscores, digits, and @acronym{ASCII} letters,
13468 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
13469 work well with other names.
13472 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
13473 specifies the program to invoke; it is
13474 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
13475 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
13476 The program should not be a special built-in utility
13477 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13479 @cindex environment, printing
13481 If no command name is specified following the environment
13482 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
13483 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
13485 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13486 Options must precede operands.
13490 @item -u @var{name}
13491 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
13494 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
13499 @itemx --ignore-environment
13502 @opindex --ignore-environment
13503 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
13507 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
13511 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
13512 1 if @command{env} itself fails
13513 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13514 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13515 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13519 @node nice invocation
13520 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
13524 @cindex scheduling, affecting
13525 @cindex appropriate privileges
13527 @command{nice} prints or modifies a process's @dfn{niceness},
13528 a parameter that affects whether the process is scheduled favorably.
13532 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13535 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
13536 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
13537 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
13539 Nicenesses range at least from @minus{}20 (resulting in the most
13540 favorable scheduling) through 19 (the least favorable). Some systems
13541 may have a wider range of nicenesses; conversely, other systems may
13542 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
13543 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
13544 minimum or maximum supported value.
13546 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
13547 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
13548 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
13549 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
13550 terminology, @acronym{POSIX} defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
13551 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the nonnegative difference
13552 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
13553 conforms to @acronym{POSIX}, its documentation and diagnostics use the
13554 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
13556 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13557 built-in utilities}).
13559 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
13560 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
13561 Because many shells have a built-in @command{nice} command, using an
13562 unadorned @command{nice} in a script or interactively may get you
13563 different functionality than that described here.
13565 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13566 Options must precede operands.
13569 @item -n @var{adjustment}
13570 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
13572 @opindex --adjustment
13573 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
13574 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
13575 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
13578 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
13579 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
13580 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
13584 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
13588 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
13589 1 if @command{nice} itself fails
13590 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13591 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13592 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13595 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
13598 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
13601 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
13602 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
13604 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
13615 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
13616 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
13617 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
13621 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
13625 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
13626 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
13629 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
13633 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
13637 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
13639 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
13644 @node nohup invocation
13645 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
13648 @cindex hangups, immunity to
13649 @cindex immunity to hangups
13650 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
13653 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
13654 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
13658 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
13661 If standard input is a terminal, it is redirected from
13662 @file{/dev/null} so that terminal sessions do not mistakenly consider
13663 the terminal to be used by the command. This is a @acronym{GNU}
13664 extension; programs intended to be portable to non-@acronym{GNU} hosts
13665 should use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{} </dev/null}
13669 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
13670 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
13671 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
13672 command is not run.
13673 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
13674 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
13675 regardless of the current umask settings.
13677 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
13678 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
13679 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
13680 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
13681 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
13683 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
13684 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
13688 nohup make > make.log
13691 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
13692 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
13693 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
13694 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
13695 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
13697 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13698 built-in utilities}).
13700 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13701 options}. Options must precede operands.
13703 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
13707 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13708 127 if @command{nohup} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
13709 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13713 @node su invocation
13714 @section @command{su}: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
13717 @cindex substitute user and group IDs
13718 @cindex user ID, switching
13719 @cindex super-user, becoming
13720 @cindex root, becoming
13722 @command{su} allows one user to temporarily become another user. It runs a
13723 command (often an interactive shell) with the real and effective user
13724 ID, group ID, and supplemental groups of a given @var{user}. Synopsis:
13727 su [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13730 @cindex passwd entry, and @command{su} shell
13732 @flindex /etc/passwd
13733 If no @var{user} is given, the default is @code{root}, the super-user.
13734 The shell to use is taken from @var{user}'s @code{passwd} entry, or
13735 @file{/bin/sh} if none is specified there. If @var{user} has a
13736 password, @command{su} prompts for the password unless run by a user with
13737 effective user ID of zero (the super-user).
13743 @cindex login shell
13744 By default, @command{su} does not change the current directory.
13745 It sets the environment variables @env{HOME} and @env{SHELL}
13746 from the password entry for @var{user}, and if @var{user} is not
13747 the super-user, sets @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME} to @var{user}.
13748 By default, the shell is not a login shell.
13750 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
13753 @cindex @option{-su}
13754 GNU @command{su} does not treat @file{/bin/sh} or any other shells specially
13755 (e.g., by setting @code{argv[0]} to @option{-su}, passing @option{-c} only
13756 to certain shells, etc.).
13759 @command{su} can optionally be compiled to use @code{syslog} to report
13760 failed, and optionally successful, @command{su} attempts. (If the system
13761 supports @code{syslog}.) However, GNU @command{su} does not check if the
13762 user is a member of the @code{wheel} group; see below.
13764 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13767 @item -c @var{command}
13768 @itemx --command=@var{command}
13771 Pass @var{command}, a single command line to run, to the shell with
13772 a @option{-c} option instead of starting an interactive shell.
13779 @cindex file name pattern expansion, disabled
13780 @cindex globbing, disabled
13781 Pass the @option{-f} option to the shell. This probably only makes sense
13782 if the shell run is @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}, for which the @option{-f}
13783 option prevents reading the startup file (@file{.cshrc}). With
13784 Bourne-like shells, the @option{-f} option disables file name pattern
13785 expansion (globbing), which is not likely to be useful.
13793 @c other variables already indexed above
13796 @cindex login shell, creating
13797 Make the shell a login shell. This means the following. Unset all
13798 environment variables except @env{TERM}, @env{HOME}, and @env{SHELL}
13799 (which are set as described above), and @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME}
13800 (which are set, even for the super-user, as described above), and set
13801 @env{PATH} to a compiled-in default value. Change to @var{user}'s home
13802 directory. Prepend @samp{-} to the shell's name, intended to make it
13803 read its login startup file(s).
13807 @itemx --preserve-environment
13810 @opindex --preserve-environment
13811 @cindex environment, preserving
13812 @flindex /etc/shells
13813 @cindex restricted shell
13814 Do not change the environment variables @env{HOME}, @env{USER},
13815 @env{LOGNAME}, or @env{SHELL}. Run the shell given in the environment
13816 variable @env{SHELL} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd
13817 entry, unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and
13818 @var{user}'s shell is restricted. A @dfn{restricted shell} is one that
13819 is not listed in the file @file{/etc/shells}, or in a compiled-in list
13820 if that file does not exist. Parts of what this option does can be
13821 overridden by @option{--login} and @option{--shell}.
13823 @item -s @var{shell}
13824 @itemx --shell=@var{shell}
13827 Run @var{shell} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd entry,
13828 unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and @var{user}'s
13829 shell is restricted (see @option{-m} just above).
13833 @cindex exit status of @command{su}
13837 1 if @command{su} itself fails
13838 126 if subshell is found but cannot be invoked
13839 127 if subshell cannot be found
13840 the exit status of the subshell otherwise
13843 @cindex wheel group, not supported
13844 @cindex group wheel, not supported
13846 @subsection Why GNU @command{su} does not support the @samp{wheel} group
13848 (This section is by Richard Stallman.)
13852 Sometimes a few of the users try to hold total power over all the
13853 rest. For example, in 1984, a few users at the MIT AI lab decided to
13854 seize power by changing the operator password on the Twenex system and
13855 keeping it secret from everyone else. (I was able to thwart this coup
13856 and give power back to the users by patching the kernel, but I
13857 wouldn't know how to do that in Unix.)
13859 However, occasionally the rulers do tell someone. Under the usual
13860 @command{su} mechanism, once someone learns the root password who
13861 sympathizes with the ordinary users, he or she can tell the rest. The
13862 ``wheel group'' feature would make this impossible, and thus cement the
13863 power of the rulers.
13865 I'm on the side of the masses, not that of the rulers. If you are
13866 used to supporting the bosses and sysadmins in whatever they do, you
13867 might find this idea strange at first.
13870 @node Process control
13871 @chapter Process control
13873 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
13874 @cindex commands for controlling processes
13877 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
13881 @node kill invocation
13882 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
13885 @cindex send a signal to processes
13887 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
13888 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
13889 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
13892 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
13893 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
13896 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
13897 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
13898 is @samp{TERM}. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
13899 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
13900 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
13902 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
13903 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
13904 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
13905 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
13906 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
13907 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
13908 value of @var{pid}.
13910 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
13911 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
13914 If a negative @var{PID} argument is desired as the first one, it
13915 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
13916 @acronym{POSIX}, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
13917 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
13926 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
13927 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
13929 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
13930 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
13931 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
13932 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
13933 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
13934 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
13935 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
13936 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
13937 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
13938 and if there is no output error.
13940 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
13941 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
13943 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
13944 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
13945 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
13946 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
13947 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
13948 ambiguity with lower case option letters. The following signal names
13949 and numbers are supported on all @acronym{POSIX} compliant systems:
13955 2. Terminal interrupt.
13961 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
13969 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
13970 numbers. All systems conforming to @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 also
13971 support the following signals:
13975 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
13977 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
13979 Continue executing, if stopped.
13981 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
13983 Illegal Instruction.
13985 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
13987 Invalid memory reference.
13989 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
13993 Background process attempting read.
13995 Background process attempting write.
13997 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
13999 User-defined signal 1.
14001 User-defined signal 2.
14005 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XSI} extension
14006 also support the following signals:
14012 Profiling timer expired.
14016 Trace/breakpoint trap.
14018 Virtual timer expired.
14020 CPU time limit exceeded.
14022 File size limit exceeded.
14026 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XRT} extension
14027 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
14028 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
14034 @cindex delaying commands
14035 @cindex commands for delaying
14037 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
14040 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
14044 @node sleep invocation
14045 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
14048 @cindex delay for a specified time
14050 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
14051 the values of the command line arguments.
14055 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
14059 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
14060 is seconds. The units are:
14073 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
14074 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
14075 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
14076 arbitrary floating point numbers (using a period before any fractional
14079 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14085 @node Numeric operations
14086 @chapter Numeric operations
14088 @cindex numeric operations
14089 These programs do numerically-related operations.
14092 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
14093 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
14097 @node factor invocation
14098 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
14101 @cindex prime factors
14103 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
14106 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
14107 factor @var{option}
14110 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
14111 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
14113 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14116 The algorithm it uses is not very sophisticated, so for some inputs
14117 @command{factor} runs for a long time. The hardest numbers to factor are
14118 the products of large primes. Factoring the product of the two largest 32-bit
14119 prime numbers takes about 80 seconds of CPU time on a 1.6 GHz Athlon.
14122 $ p=`echo '4294967279 * 4294967291'|bc`
14124 18446743979220271189: 4294967279 4294967291
14127 Similarly, it takes about 80 seconds for GNU factor (from coreutils-5.1.2)
14128 to ``factor'' the largest 64-bit prime:
14131 $ factor 18446744073709551557
14132 18446744073709551557: 18446744073709551557
14135 In contrast, @command{factor} factors the largest 64-bit number in just
14136 over a tenth of a second:
14139 $ factor `echo '2^64-1'|bc`
14140 18446744073709551615: 3 5 17 257 641 65537 6700417
14146 @node seq invocation
14147 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
14150 @cindex numeric sequences
14151 @cindex sequence of numbers
14153 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
14156 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
14157 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
14158 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
14161 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
14162 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
14163 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
14164 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
14165 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
14166 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
14167 Floating-point numbers
14168 may be specified (using a period before any fractional digits).
14170 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14171 Options must precede operands.
14174 @item -f @var{format}
14175 @itemx --format=@var{format}
14176 @opindex -f @var{format}
14177 @opindex --format=@var{format}
14178 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
14179 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
14180 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
14181 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
14182 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}.
14183 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
14184 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
14185 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
14186 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
14187 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
14188 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
14190 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
14191 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
14192 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
14193 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
14194 the default format is @samp{%g}.
14196 @item -s @var{string}
14197 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
14198 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
14199 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
14200 The output always terminates with a newline.
14203 @itemx --equal-width
14204 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
14205 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
14206 decimal representation.
14207 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
14211 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
14214 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
14220 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
14221 to perform the conversion:
14224 $ printf '%x\n' `seq 1048575 1024 1050623`
14230 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
14231 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
14234 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
14240 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
14243 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
14244 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
14245 differ depending on your floating-point implementation, but a common
14246 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
14247 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
14250 $ seq 18446744073709551616 1 18446744073709551618
14251 18446744073709551616
14252 18446744073709551616
14253 18446744073709551618
14256 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
14257 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
14258 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
14259 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
14262 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
14265 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
14270 @node File permissions
14271 @chapter File permissions
14274 @include getdate.texi
14278 @node Opening the software toolbox
14279 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
14281 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
14282 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
14283 @cite{What's GNU?} column of @cite{Linux Journal}, 2 (June, 1994)}.
14284 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
14287 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
14288 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
14289 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
14290 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
14291 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
14292 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
14293 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
14297 @node Toolbox introduction
14298 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
14300 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
14301 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system and how they
14302 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
14303 of program development and usage.
14305 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
14306 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
14307 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
14308 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
14309 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
14310 for solving many kinds of problems.
14312 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
14313 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
14314 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
14315 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
14316 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
14318 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
14319 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
14320 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
14321 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
14322 with the handle of his screwdriver.
14324 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
14325 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
14326 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
14331 difficult to write,
14334 difficult to maintain and
14338 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
14341 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
14342 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
14343 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
14345 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
14346 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
14347 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
14348 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
14349 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
14350 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
14351 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
14352 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
14353 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
14355 @node I/O redirection
14356 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
14358 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
14359 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
14360 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
14361 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
14362 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
14363 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
14364 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
14365 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
14366 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
14369 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
14372 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
14375 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
14376 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
14377 it is in the desired form.
14379 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
14380 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
14381 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
14382 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
14383 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
14384 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
14385 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
14386 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
14387 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
14389 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
14390 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
14391 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
14392 lines delimited by the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed) character,
14393 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
14394 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
14395 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
14396 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
14397 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
14398 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
14399 data with a text editor.)
14401 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
14402 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
14403 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
14404 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
14405 for the full story.
14407 @node The who command
14408 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
14410 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
14411 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
14412 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
14417 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
14418 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
14419 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
14420 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
14423 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
14424 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
14425 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
14426 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
14427 but the data is not all that exciting.
14429 @node The cut command
14430 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
14432 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
14433 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
14434 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
14435 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
14439 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
14442 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
14445 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
14446 @print{} root:Operator
14448 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
14449 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
14453 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
14454 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
14455 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
14456 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
14458 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
14469 @node The sort command
14470 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
14472 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
14473 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
14474 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
14477 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
14478 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
14479 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
14480 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
14481 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
14484 @node The uniq command
14485 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
14487 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
14488 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
14489 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
14490 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
14491 standard input. It prints only one
14492 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
14493 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
14494 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
14497 @node Putting the tools together
14498 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
14500 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
14501 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a program that will
14502 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
14503 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
14506 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
14507 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
14508 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
14509 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
14510 by generating just a list of logged on users:
14520 Next, sort the list:
14523 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
14530 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
14533 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14539 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
14540 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
14541 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
14543 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it available for
14544 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
14545 or @code{root}, prompt):
14548 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
14549 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14551 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
14554 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
14555 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
14556 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
14557 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
14558 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
14559 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
14560 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
14563 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
14564 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
14565 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
14567 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
14568 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
14569 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
14571 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
14572 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
14573 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
14576 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
14577 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
14579 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
14580 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
14581 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
14585 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
14586 @print{} this example has mixed case!
14589 There are several options of interest:
14593 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
14594 operations apply to characters not in the given set
14597 delete characters in the first set from the output
14600 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
14603 We will be using all three options in a moment.
14605 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
14606 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
14607 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
14608 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
14609 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
14610 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
14611 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
14633 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
14634 instead of a regular file.
14636 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
14637 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
14640 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
14641 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
14644 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
14647 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
14648 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
14652 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
14655 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
14656 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
14657 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
14658 be left alone. (The @acronym{ASCII} tab character should also be included for
14659 good measure in a production script.)
14661 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
14662 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
14663 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
14664 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
14667 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14668 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
14671 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
14672 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
14673 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
14674 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
14675 typing in all of a command.)
14677 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
14678 case. We're ready to count each word:
14681 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14682 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
14685 At this point, the data might look something like this:
14698 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
14699 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
14700 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
14704 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
14707 reverse the order of the sort
14710 The final pipeline looks like this:
14713 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14714 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
14723 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
14724 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
14725 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
14726 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
14728 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
14729 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
14730 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
14731 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
14732 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
14733 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
14734 revision of this article.}
14735 this is a is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
14737 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
14738 a sorted list of words, one per line:
14741 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14742 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
14745 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
14746 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
14749 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14750 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
14751 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
14754 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
14755 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
14756 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
14757 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
14758 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
14759 spelling checker on Unix.
14761 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
14765 search files for text that matches a regular expression
14768 count lines, words, characters
14771 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
14774 the stream editor, an advanced tool
14777 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
14780 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
14781 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
14782 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
14783 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
14789 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
14792 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
14793 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
14794 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
14797 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
14798 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
14801 Let someone else do the hard part.
14804 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
14805 appropriate tool, build one.
14808 As of this writing, all the programs we've discussed are available via
14809 anonymous @command{ftp} from: @*
14810 @uref{ftp://gnudist.gnu.org/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz}. (There may
14811 be more recent versions available now.)
14813 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
14814 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
14815 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
14816 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
14817 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
14818 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
14819 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
14820 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
14821 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
14824 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
14825 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
14826 still in print and are well worth
14827 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
14828 how I view programming.
14830 The programs in both books are available from
14831 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
14832 For a number of years, there was an active
14833 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
14834 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
14835 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
14836 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
14838 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
14839 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
14840 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
14841 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
14842 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
14844 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
14845 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
14847 @node GNU Free Documentation License
14848 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
14852 @node Concept index
14861 @c Local variables:
14862 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32